summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
path: root/44671-8.txt
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
authornfenwick <nfenwick@pglaf.org>2025-03-03 18:33:44 -0800
committernfenwick <nfenwick@pglaf.org>2025-03-03 18:33:44 -0800
commit4ef2adf1c76b8e8154af042c9d5a9d80b65562d8 (patch)
treece82bd330f0b7b1667ab9fbc8ae8ed688190823b /44671-8.txt
parent60d5e94610eb7654777609cb3279822d45bb9669 (diff)
Add files from ibiblio as of 2025-03-03 18:33:44HEADmain
Diffstat (limited to '44671-8.txt')
-rw-r--r--44671-8.txt7994
1 files changed, 0 insertions, 7994 deletions
diff --git a/44671-8.txt b/44671-8.txt
deleted file mode 100644
index 4f828e0..0000000
--- a/44671-8.txt
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,7994 +0,0 @@
-The Project Gutenberg EBook of Jack in the Rockies, by George Bird Grinnell
-
-This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
-almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
-re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
-with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
-
-
-Title: Jack in the Rockies
- A Boy's Adventures with a Pack Train
-
-Author: George Bird Grinnell
-
-Illustrator: Edwin Willard Deming
-
-Release Date: January 15, 2014 [EBook #44671]
-
-Language: English
-
-Character set encoding: ISO-8859-1
-
-*** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK JACK IN THE ROCKIES ***
-
-
-
-
-Produced by David Edwards, Mary Akers and the Online
-Distributed Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net (This
-file was produced from images generously made available
-by The Internet Archive)
-
-
-
-
-
-Transcriber's note:
- Spelling and punctuation inconsistencies been harmonized.
- Obvious printer errors have been repaired. Italic text has been
- marked with _underscores_. Please see the end of this book for
- further notes.
-
-
-
-
-JACK IN THE ROCKIES
-
-
-
-
-_By the same Author_
-
-
- JACK THE YOUNG COWBOY
- JACK THE YOUNG TRAPPER
- JACK THE YOUNG CANOEMAN
- JACK THE YOUNG EXPLORER
- JACK IN THE ROCKIES
- JACK AMONG THE INDIANS
- JACK THE YOUNG RANCHMAN
- PAWNEE HERO STORIES AND FOLK TALES
- BLACKFOOT LODGE TALES
- THE STORY OF THE INDIAN
- THE INDIANS OF TO-DAY
- THE PUNISHMENT OF THE STINGY
- AMERICAN DUCK SHOOTING
- AMERICAN GAME BIRD SHOOTING
- TRAILS OF THE PATHFINDERS
-
-
-
- [Illustration: "THROWING HIS GUN TO HIS SHOULDER HE FIRED
- AT THE ANIMAL." _Page 221_]
-
-
-
-
- JACK
- IN THE ROCKIES
-
- OR
- A BOY'S ADVENTURES WITH A PACK TRAIN
-
- BY
- GEORGE BIRD GRINNELL
-
- _Author of_ "_Jack the Young Ranchman_," "_Jack Among the Indians_,"
- "_Pawnee Hero Stories_," "_Blackfoot Lodge Tales_,"
- "_The Story of the Indian_," "_The Indian
- of To-Day_," _Etc._
-
- _Illustrated by_
- EDWIN WILLARD DEMING
-
-
- [Illustration]
-
-
-
-
- NEW YORK FREDERICK A. STOKES COMPANY PUBLISHERS
-
-
-
-
- Copyright, 1904,
- BY FREDERICK A. STOKES COMPANY
-
-
- _All rights reserved_
-
- _Thirteenth Printing_
-
-
- _Printed in the United States of America_
-
-
-
-
-CONTENTS
-
-
- CHAPTER PAGE
-
- I THE INDIANS OF FORT BERTHOLD 9
-
- II THE BATTLE OF THE MUSSELSHELL 27
-
- III THE START FOR THE BLACKFOOT CAMP 43
-
- IV OLD FRIENDS AND NEW 56
-
- V BUFFALO HUNTING WITH THE BLACKFEET 73
-
- VI AMID WONDERS OF THE YELLOWSTONE
- PARK 86
-
- VII GEYSERS AND HOT SPRINGS 97
-
- VIII ACROSS THE CONTINENTAL DIVIDE 109
-
- IX AN ELK HUNT UNDER THE TETONS 122
-
- X TRAILING BLACK-TAILS 137
-
- XI TRACKS IN THE SNOW 147
-
- XII WHAT WILL BECOME OF THE ELK? 160
-
- XIII A PACK HORSE IN DANGER 172
-
- XIV A BIGHORN 180
-
- XV A CHARGING GRIZZLY 189
-
- XVI SOMETHING ABOUT BEARS 194
-
- XVII THE STORY OF A MAN KILLER 202
-
- XVIII JACK'S FIRST MOOSE 216
-
- XIX WATCHING A BEAR BAIT 228
-
- XX A PUZZLING TRAIL 240
-
- XXI HUGH GOES "ON DISCOVERY" 248
-
- XXII STEALING FROM HORSE THIEVES 257
-
- XXIII "DIED WITH HIS BOOTS ON" 266
-
-
-
-
-ILLUSTRATIONS
-
-
- "THROWING HIS GUN TO HIS SHOULDER
- HE FIRED AT THE ANIMAL" _Frontispiece_
-
- "HE REACHED FAR FORWARD, AND GRASPED THE
- LONG HAIR ON THE BUFFALO'S HUMP" 82
-
- "ALMOST BELOW THEM, FEEDING, WERE TWO
- GOOD SIZED RAMS" 183
-
- "'HANDS UP'! HUGH CALLED" 268
-
-
-
-
-FOREWORD
-
-
-At the time Jack Danvers journeyed through the Yellowstone National
-Park, that wonderful country was little known. Since then it has
-become famous, and people from all parts of the globe go to visit
-it. There is no more delightful summer excursion possible than a
-trip to the National Park where--if one can take a pack train and
-journey away from the beaten roads and trails--it is still possible
-to see elk and deer and many other wild animals, almost in their
-old time abundance.
-
-In the spring of 1903 President Roosevelt did just this, and on his
-return wrote a most interesting article about what he saw, telling
-of the abundance of the elk, the familiarity of the deer, the
-shyness of the antelope and the tameness of the mountain sheep.
-
-American boys and girls are happy in having in their own country so
-lovely and so marvelous a region.
-
-
-
-
-Jack in the Rockies
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER I
-
-THE INDIANS OF FORT BERTHOLD
-
-
-With noisy puffings the steamboat was slowly pushing her way
-up the river. On either side the flat bottom, in some places
-overgrown with high willow brush, in others, bearing a growth of
-tall and sturdy cottonwoods, ran back a long way to the yellow
-bluffs beyond. The bluffs were rounded and several hundred feet in
-height, rising imperceptibly until they seemed to meet the blue
-of the sky, so that the boat appeared to be moving at the bottom
-of a wide trough. Hour after hour she pushed on, meeting nothing,
-seeing nothing alive, except now and then a pair of great gray
-geese, followed by their yellow goslings; or sometimes on the shore
-a half-concealed red object, which moved quickly out of sight, and
-which observers knew to be a deer.
-
-On the boat were two of our old friends. From the far East had
-come Jack Danvers, traveling day after day until he had reached
-Bismarck, Dakota, where he found awaiting him Hugh Johnson, as
-grave, as white-haired, and as cheery as ever. At Bismarck they
-had taken the up-river steamer, "Josephine," and the boat had
-sailed early on the morning of July 5th.
-
-Hugh and Jack were on their way back up to the Piegan country. They
-had separated at Bismarck the previous autumn, and while Hugh kept
-on down the river, to take a west-bound train, which should carry
-him back to Mr. Sturgis' ranch in Wyoming, Jack had gone East, to
-spend the winter in New York. He had had a year of hard work at
-school, for his experience of the previous winter had taught him
-that it paid well to work in school, and to make the most of his
-opportunities there. This made his parents more willing to have him
-go away to this healthful life, and he found that if he did his
-best he enjoyed all the better the wild, free life of the prairie
-and the mountains, which he now hoped would be his during a part,
-at least, of every year.
-
-His summer with the Piegans had taught him many things known to
-few boys in the East, and given him many pleasures to which they
-are strangers; and the more he saw of this prairie life the more
-he enjoyed it, and the more he hoped to have more and more of it.
-Sometimes, when he awoke early in the morning, or at night, after
-he had gone to bed, as he lay between sleeping and waking, he used
-to go over in his mind the scenes that he had visited, and the
-stirring adventures in which he had taken part, and these memories,
-with the hope of others like them, gave him a pleasure that he
-would not have parted with for anything.
-
-Often when he was in New York, walking through narrow city
-streets, looking up at high buildings, hearing the roar and rattle
-of the passing traffic, and watching the people hurry to and fro,
-each one absorbed in his own business, it was hard to realize that
-away off somewhere, only a few days' journey distant, there was a
-land where there was no limit to the view, where each human being
-seemed absolutely free, and where it was possible to travel for
-days and days without seeing a single person. Always interwoven
-with his dreams and his imaginings about this distant country was
-the memory of the friend Hugh, to whom he was so deeply attached.
-It hardly seemed to him possible to go anywhere in the West, except
-in company with Hugh, and until he had joined him, it never seemed
-as if his journey had begun, or was really going to be made.
-
-All through the day the boat went on, turning and twisting, and
-at different times facing all points of the compass. Sometimes
-the sun would be shining on the port side of the boat, a little
-later on the starboard side, then it would be ahead, and again
-behind. Hugh and Jack spent their time chatting on the upper deck
-of the boat, Hugh smoking vigorously, to keep off the mosquitoes,
-while Jack, the edges of his handkerchief under his hat and tucked
-inside his coat collar, to leeward of Hugh, took advantage of the
-constant stream of smoke that poured from his pipe. They had much
-to tell each other of the winter that had passed, and much to say
-of the trip on which they were now starting. Fort Benton was their
-destination, and until they reached there, and saw their friend
-Joe, the Blackfoot Indian who was to meet them with the horses,
-they were uncertain what they should do.
-
-There were not a few passengers on the boat. Some of them were
-carefully dressed persons, wearing long frock coats, white shirts,
-and a modest amount of jewelry, residents of the thriving towns
-of Helena or Virginia City, Montana; others were army officers,
-on their way to posts in the Northwest, or now starting out on
-some exploring expedition; while others still were persons of
-whose occupation and destination it was hard to judge from their
-appearance.
-
-Among them was a middle-aged man who Jack thought, from his
-conversation, had long been a resident of the plains, and who told
-Jack something about a trade that he had long practised--that of
-wolfing.
-
-"Why, young fellow," he said, "it is only a few years ago since
-there was good money in wolfin', but I had to quit it down in the
-southern country for wolves got too scarce when the buffalo got
-killed off. Wherever there was buffalo there was plenty of wolves,
-for the wolves made their livin' off the herds, just like the
-Indians; and when I say wolves I mean big wolves, coyotes, foxes,
-and swifts.
-
-"In the autumn, as soon as the fur began to get good, I used to
-start out and find a herd of buffalo, and after shootin' two or
-three of them, I'd skin them down, and rip them up, and put from
-one to three bottles of strychnine in each carcass. After the blood
-that lay in the ribs had been poisoned good, I'd smear that over
-the meat on the outside. Generally I'd try to kill my buffalo
-close to where I was goin' to camp, and after I had put out my
-baits I went to camp and slept until near day. Then, before I could
-see, I'd get up, cook my breakfast, hitch up, if I had a team,
-and go round to all my baits. Likely, around each one I'd find my
-half dozen to fifteen wolves, and sometimes it would take me two
-or three days to skin them. Likely enough, if the weather turned
-right cold, I got a good many more wolves than I could skin, and
-had to stack them up, and wait till I got time. It was mighty hard
-work now, and don't you forget it. Then, too, there was always a
-chance that Indians might come along and make trouble for me. You
-take a man out on the prairie, ten years ago, and even the friendly
-Indians were likely to scare him a whole lot, or take his hides,
-even if they didn't take away his gun and his horses. As for the
-hostiles, if they got too close to a man it was all up with him.
-But I never had no trouble with them, except once, and then I was
-camped in the dug-out, with plenty of provisions, and there was
-only three of the Indians. I saw them comin', and suspected who
-they were, and managed to get my horses into the dug-out with me
-and stood 'em off. They scared me bad though.
-
-"I should think so," said Jack.
-
-The man stopped talking to fill his pipe and after he had lighted
-it puffed thoughtfully. Then he continued: "There's another way
-I've wolfed it, and that is by draggin' a bait over quite a scope
-of country, and droppin' pieces of poisoned meat along the trail.
-I used to do that when I couldn't find animals to kill for bait.
-This worked pretty well for awhile but it's no good any more down
-in that country."
-
-"I've seen coyotes killed by putting poisoned tallow in auger
-holes, bored in chunks of wood," said Jack.
-
-"Yes," said the man, "that's good sometimes, and they stay there
-lickin' and lickin' up the bait until they die right there. You
-don't have to look over much country to find your wolves."
-
-"What kind of meat did you use when you were dragging the bait?"
-asked Jack.
-
-"Most any kind would do," replied the wolfer; "sometimes it would
-be a piece of buffalo meat, sometimes a shoulder of a deer, but
-the best bait of all is a beaver carcass; there's lots of grease
-and lots of smell to that, and the wolves and coyotes are sure to
-follow it. This draggin' a trail is good too, because the wolves,
-when they go along and snap up the poisoned bait, don't go off, but
-keep right on followin' the trail, and you find them there, maybe
-quite a long way from where they pick the bait.
-
-"Where are you goin', young fellow; you and that old man I see you
-talking with?"
-
-"We're going up to Benton," said Jack, "and I don't know where
-we're going from there. I expect we'll meet a friend there, with
-our horses, and then we're going to make a trip, off maybe on the
-prairies, and maybe into the mountains; we can't tell yet."
-
-"Sho," said the man, "you're sure goin' to have a good time. I've
-got to get a job when I get to Benton; somethin' that'll keep me
-until it comes time for fur to get good."
-
-The next morning when Jack and Hugh left their stateroom a heavy
-fog hung low over the river and the boat was not moving, but was
-tied up to the bank, for it was so thick that there was danger of
-running aground on the frequent sand-bars, and as the river was
-now falling, the captain was unwilling to take the chance of such
-delay. On the lower deck was a dug-out canoe, the property of a
-temporary passenger, who was going only to Fort Berthold, and,
-after breakfast, Jack suggested to Hugh that they should borrow
-this canoe and go off a little way up the river, taking their guns,
-and seeing whether they could kill anything. Hugh said this could
-not be done, explaining that it would be easy enough to get lost,
-which would be bad for them, and very irritating to the captain,
-who might feel it necessary to wait for them; and besides this,
-the fog might lift at any moment, when the boat would move onward
-much faster than they could paddle. As it happened, the fog lifted
-almost immediately, and the boat set forward; and a little before
-noon the village of the Rees, Gros Ventres and Mandans, high up on
-the bluff above the river, was seen; and soon after the boat tied
-up, and all hands went ashore.
-
-The bluff rose steeply from the river, and up and down its face
-were steep trails, worn by the feet of women passing up and down
-as they carried water and the driftwood which they gathered, up to
-the village. On the top of the bluff stood the bee-hive shaped gray
-houses, which Hugh told Jack were much like those occupied by the
-Pawnees.
-
-They began to climb the bluff toward the village, and Jack asked
-Hugh about the Indians who lived here.
-
-"In old times," said Hugh, "these Indians were scattered out up and
-down the river. The Gros Ventres lived furthest up, between here
-and Buford, and the Rees and Mandans lived further down the stream.
-A long time ago,--back maybe more than a hundred years,--the Rees
-and the Mandans all lived together, away down below here; but then
-they had some sort of a quarrel among themselves, and the Mandans
-moved on up the stream, and for a long time camped near the mouth
-of the Knife River. For a while after that there was some fighting
-between the Rees and Mandans, but after a time they made peace,
-and gradually the tribes came together again; and now for a long
-time they've all lived together in this village of Berthold. In old
-times each of these villages was a big one, but since the white
-men came among them, and brought smallpox, and liquor, and all the
-other things that the white men bring, they are dying off fast, and
-I don't believe that now there is more than eight or nine hundred
-of these Indians all together. You know these Rees here are kind
-of kin to the Pawnees; they speak near the same language, so that
-I can talk with 'em, and they call the Pawnees their relations. I
-think they used to be a part of the Skidi band. Nobody knows just
-when they separated from the Pawnees, but it must have been a good
-while ago."
-
-Hugh paused, and Jack asked: "Does any one know how they came to
-separate, Hugh? Is there any tradition about it?"
-
-"Yes," said Hugh, "there is. The old story is that all the Pawnees
-were out hunting, and the Sioux got around some of 'em, and cut
-'em off from the rest and kept fighting 'em, and driving 'em, and
-fighting and driving, until they got 'em away up on the Missouri
-River, so far from their friends that they had to winter there.
-Then, along back, maybe about 1830, soon after the beginning of the
-fur trade on the upper river, the Rees fought the white folks, and
-were generally hostile. After that they went back and joined the
-Pawnees, but they couldn't get along well with the Pawnees, and
-quarreled with them, and finally the Pawnees drove 'em off. So they
-came on back up the river. It was after that that they joined the
-Mandans, and they've lived together ever since."
-
-By this time they had reached the top of the bluff, and were now
-close to the houses, on whose curious domed roofs many people were
-sitting,--women busy with their work, young men wrapped in their
-robes, and looking off into the distance, and little girls playing
-with their dolls or their puppies. The ground in the village all
-about the houses was worn bare by the passage of many feet; Indians
-were going to and fro, women carrying water and wood, men naked, or
-wrapped in their summer sheets, little boys chasing each other, or,
-with their ropes trying to snare the dogs, which were usually too
-cunning for them.
-
-Jack was greatly interested in the houses, and wished to look
-into one, and to this Hugh said there would be no objection. The
-entrance of each house was by a long passage-way, closed above,
-and at the sides, and passing through this, they found themselves
-at the door. Jack expected to go into a room that was dark; but
-this was not so. Above the center of the large room was a wide
-open space, which answered both for chimney and for window. About
-the fireplace, which was under the smoke hole, at the corners of a
-square, stood four stout posts, reaching up to and supporting the
-rafters of the roof. The floor of the house was swept clean, and
-all around the walls were raised platforms, serving for beds, and
-separated by screens of straight willow sticks strung on sinew,
-from the adjacent bed on either side. In front of some of the beds
-similar screens hung down like curtains so that the bed could
-be cut off from the observation of those in the house. Over the
-fireplace hung a pot, and two pleasant-faced women were sitting
-near it, sewing moccasins. They looked up pleasantly, as the
-strangers stood in the doorway, and Hugh spoke a few words to them,
-to which they made some answer. Then the strangers withdrew.
-
-Keeping on through the village, they walked out on the higher
-prairie, toward the tribal burying-ground, but not such a
-burying-ground as Jack was accustomed to see. Here were placed the
-dead, wrapped up in bundles, on platforms raised on four poles,
-eight or ten feet above the ground. Evidently no attention was paid
-to them after burial, for many of the poles which supported the
-platforms had rotted and fallen down, and, in the older part of
-the graveyard the ground was strewn with pieces of old robes and
-clothing, and with white bones.
-
-Hugh told Jack that farther away, and down on lower ground, where
-the soil was moist, the Rees, Mandans, and Gros Ventres had farms,
-where they raised corn, beans, pumpkins, and squashes, and that in
-old times they used to raise tobacco.
-
-It was now time to return to the boat, for the wait was to be only
-a short one, and on their way back he told of something that had
-happened not many years before in the Mandan village.
-
-"The people were hungry," said Hugh, "and there was no food in
-camp. They sent young men off in all directions to look for
-buffalo, but none could be found. As the people grew hungrier and
-hungrier the White Cow Society made up their minds that they would
-give a dance, and try to bring the buffalo. They did this, and
-danced for a long time; but no buffalo were found, and there were
-no signs that any were coming. Still the people of the White Cow
-Society danced, and still the other people watched them, and prayed
-that they might bring the buffalo. One day, after they'd danced
-for ten days, suddenly a big noise was heard in the village, and
-when the people rushed out of the lodges to see what was happening,
-there, among the lodges, was a big buffalo bull, charging about
-right close to the lodge in which the White Cow Society were
-dancing. All the dogs in the village seemed to be about him,
-barking at his head, and biting at his heels, and he was trying
-only to get away, and paying no attention to the Indians that were
-all about him.
-
-"Then everybody was glad, for all could see that the Master of Life
-had sent this bull, to answer their prayers; and all believed that
-he had come ahead of the main herd, which would soon follow him.
-Before he had got out of the village, the bull was shot. The White
-Cow Society came out of their lodge, and danced around the village,
-and while they were doin' this, one of the scouts came in, and
-reported that a big band of cows was not far off. Then everybody
-was glad, and all wondered at the strong medicine of the White Cow
-Society. The next day the men went out and made a surround, and
-killed plenty of cows, and brought in the meat, and there came a
-terrible storm, and when the storm cleared off the whole prairie,
-beyond the ridge near Knife River, was black with buffalo. Now
-there was plenty in the camp, and every one was happy. The men went
-out and brought in fat meat, and it was dried, and no more that
-winter was there any suffering for food."
-
-"That's a good story, Hugh," said Jack, "but do you suppose the
-dancing of the White Cow Society really brought the buffalo?"
-
-"I couldn't tell you, son. The Indians believed it did, but I don't
-suppose any white folks would. But I've seen so many queer things
-follow these medicine performances that I don't know what to think
-about them, myself."
-
-By this time they had reached the shore, and looking around, as
-they passed over the gang-plank to the deck, they saw the captain
-and purser coming down the trail just behind them. The deck hands
-were already beginning to cast off the fasts, and a moment later
-the whistle sounded, the boat's nose turned out into the river, and
-the steady thump, thump of the paddle-wheel began again. On the
-bank stood the three or four white men belonging to the agency,
-and up and down the bottom, and clustered in little groups on the
-bluffs, were Indians, dressed in buckskin, or in bright-colored
-cloth, who stood motionless, watching the steamer as she slowly
-moved away.
-
-"That's a mighty interesting place, Hugh; and I want to get you to
-tell me all about it. Who are the Gros Ventres, and who are the
-Mandans? You've told me about the Rees, but I want to know about
-the others."
-
-"Well, son," said Hugh, "I don't know as I can tell you very much
-about them, but I'll try. The Gros Ventres are close relations
-to the Crows; in fact, many people call them the River Crows, to
-distinguish them from the real Crows, that live up close to the
-mountains, on the head of the Yellowstone. Those fellows are called
-the Mountain Crows, and there's a good many more of them than
-there are of these. These people, I suppose, got their name, Gros
-Ventres, from the French, and I never heard why it was given to
-'em. I never could see that they were any fatter, or had any bigger
-bellies, than other Indians, and I never found out any reason for
-the name. They don't call themselves by any such name as that;
-their name for themselves is _Hi d[)a]t sa_, and that's said to
-mean, willows. Anyhow, they used to be called Willow Indians; so I
-have been told.
-
-"In old times, they say that there were three tribes of them, but
-the other tribes have been lost, or forgotten, and now they're all
-together--all one bunch of Indians. There's one thing you want
-to remember, that there are two different outfits of Indians,
-both called Gros Ventres; one of them, these people here, whom we
-know as the Gros Ventres of the Village, or Gros Ventres of the
-Missouri; the others are the Gros Ventres of the Prairie, whose
-country is east of the Blackfoot country, and who used to be
-friendly with the Blackfeet, and then fought them for a long time,
-and now are friendly again. Those Gros Ventres of the Prairie are
-no kin at all to these people, but are a part of the Arapahoes,
-from whom, according to the old story, they split off a long, long
-time ago. They talk the Arapahoe language, and call the Arapahoes
-their own people, and still visit them back and forth. Nowadays
-they have an agency along with the Assinaboines, further west, at
-Fort Belknap, over on Milk River. Ninety-nine men out of every
-hundred get these Arapahoes and these River Crows mixed up, just
-for the reason that the French called them both Gros Ventres. Don't
-you ever do that, because when a man makes that mistake it shows
-that he don't know nothing about Indians. Try to remember that,
-will you?"
-
-"Of course I will, Hugh. I don't want to make any mistakes,
-especially now since I have been out and seen something of real
-Indians. People back East, and especially all the fellows at
-school, think that I know everything about Indians now. They're all
-the time asking me questions about them, who they are, and where
-they live, and I should hate to make any mistakes in my answers.
-Now tell me, who are the Mandans?"
-
-"I don't know as much about the Mandans as I do about the Gros
-Ventres of the Village," said Hugh, "and yet I've heard a lot about
-them. They're a kind of queer people; lots of 'em used to have
-yellow hair and gray eyes, and lots of 'em now have gray-haired
-children, same as you have seen among the Blackfeet. I got hold of
-a book once with lots of pictures of Indians in it; mighty good
-pictures, too, they were. 'T was written by a man named Catlin, who
-came up the river, painting pictures of Indians, a long time ago;
-maybe fifty years. He said he thought the Mandans were Welshmen,
-and told some story about some foreign prince that brought a
-colony of Welshmen over here, and Catlin thought that maybe the
-Mandans were descended from that colony. Anyhow they've lived by
-themselves, so the story goes, for a great many years; but I've
-heard the old men say that long, long ago the tribe came from
-away back East somewhere. They followed down a big river that ran
-from east to west, likely it may have been the Ohio River, until
-they came to the Mississippi, and then they struck off northwest,
-and camped on the Missouri, and they have been traveling up the
-Missouri, a little way at a time, for an almighty sight o' years.
-
-"This book of Catlin's that I tell you about has got a whole lot
-o' stuff about the Mandans, and it is mighty good readin'. You
-had better get hold of it sometime when you get back East; it'll
-tell you more about 'em than I can. The Mandans have always been
-farmers, and raised good crops of corn, and that and their buffalo
-give them a pretty good living. But now the buffalo are getting
-scarce, and when they give out the Mandans will have to live on
-straight corn, I am afraid. There's one thing about the Mandans
-that's worth rememberin', they make the best pots of any people
-that I know of on the plains. I expect that in old times maybe the
-Pawnees made just as good pots, but since the white folks began to
-bring brass and copper kettles into the country the Pawnees have
-forgotten how to make pots; but the Mandans still keep it up, and
-make some pots, big and little----"
-
-"Oh, Hugh!" called Jack at this moment, "Look at the buffalo!" and
-he pointed toward the high bluffs on the south side of the river,
-and there were three dark spots, running as hard as they could up
-the hill.
-
-"Sure enough," said Hugh, "there's the first buffalo we've seen.
-Don't they look like three rats scuttling off over the hills, as
-fast as they can go. Before long, now, we ought to see plenty of
-'em along the river; though we ain't likely to see many buffalo
-before we get above Buford."
-
-The boat pushed slowly up the river's muddy current, and Hugh and
-Jack continued to talk about the Indian village on the hill.
-
-"A mighty queer thing happened once at that village, son," said
-Hugh. "You've heard, maybe, that in some tribes of Indians they
-have sort of prophets, or men that foretell things that are going
-to happen. I have seen a little of that sort of thing myself,
-that I never could explain. Besides that, they've got some way of
-learning news that we don't understand anything about. Of course it
-may not be as quick as railroads and telegraphs, but its quick.
-Let me tell you something that happened there at Berthold, some
-years ago, and the man that it happened to lives in the upper
-country now, and you may likely run across him some time when you
-are up there. He is a Dutchman, and his name is Joe Butch.
-
-"Along in 1868, Joe was working at Berthold, for a trader there,
-and the trader got into some sort of a quarrel about a horse with
-old White Cow, chief of the Mandans, and I guess old White Cow was
-pretty sassy, and maybe he threatened to do something, and Joe
-killed him. Well, as soon as he had killed the old man, Joe he
-knew that that wasn't no place for him, because the Mandans would
-be pretty sure to kill him; so he hops onto his horse, and rides
-as hard as he could for Buford, that's eighty miles up the river,
-next place we stop at. When he got to Buford he found there a big
-camp of Assinaboines, and they were having a big dance, because
-the chief of the Mandans, their enemies, had just been killed.
-Now, how do you suppose those Assinaboines knew that White Cow had
-been killed? Joe didn't waste no time getting onto his horse, and
-he rode as hard as he could to Buford; and its a sure thing that
-nobody got there before him with the news. I never understood how
-they found that out, and I never expect to."
-
-"That seems a wonderful thing, Hugh," said Jack. "I don't see how
-they could have found it out if nobody told them, and if there were
-no telegraphs."
-
-"Well, it's sure there were no telegraphs," said Hugh, "and I don't
-see how anybody could have told them. Joe killed the man, and
-started on his ride right off, and had a good horse. That's one of
-the things that always beat me."
-
-The hours passed swiftly by for Jack and Hugh, as they watched
-the river banks on either side. The boat had met a flood of water
-just above Berthold, which, if it made progress against the strong
-current more slow, nevertheless saved time by deepening the water,
-so that they did not run aground on sand-bars. Several times during
-the morning, antelope were seen feeding in the bottom, lifting
-their heads to gaze at the boat, as it puffed and snorted along,
-but not being enough alarmed to take to flight. After supper that
-night, as they sat on the deck about sundown, Hugh, watching the
-banks, pointed out no less than three distant spots on the wide
-bottom, which he told Jack were bears digging roots. They were a
-long way off, yet with his glasses Jack was able to make out their
-forms, and to recognize them as bears.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER II
-
-THE BATTLE OF THE MUSSELSHELL
-
-
-Early next morning the boat stopped at Fort Buford, above the mouth
-of the Yellowstone River.
-
-The wait was to be only a short one, and no one left the boat. Jack
-was interested in looking from the upper deck at the post, where
-there were a number of soldiers, and it looked like a busy place.
-Away to the left was seen the broad current of the Yellowstone
-coming down between timbered banks. As the two friends sat on the
-upper deck and looked off toward the shore, Hugh, in response to
-some question by Jack, said:
-
-"Yes, in old fur-trading days this used to be a mighty interesting
-place. Just above here was one of the great trading posts of old
-times, and pretty much all the tribes of the northern prairie used
-to come here to get their ammunition, and whatever other stuff they
-could buy. Old man Culbertson was here for a long time, and lots
-of people from back east and from foreign parts used to come up
-the river as far as this. Sometimes they used to have great fights
-out here on this flat, when two hostile tribes would come in to
-trade and would get here at the same time. I've heard great stories
-about the way the Indians used to fight here among themselves
-almost under the walls of the post; and, then, again, sometimes
-the Indians used to crawl up as near to the fort as they could,
-and try to run off the horse herd, which would be feeding right
-out in front of the post. Sometimes they'd get 'em; sometimes they
-wouldn't, but would get one of the herders. On the whole, however,
-the place wasn't often attacked, because the Indians couldn't
-afford to quarrel with the people who furnished them with their
-goods. When 'twas Fort Union, 'twas a mighty lively place."
-
-"Why Hugh," said Jack, "do you mean to tell me that this is old
-Fort Union?"
-
-"Sure," said Hugh.
-
-"Why," said Jack, "I've read lots about Fort Union. Don't you know
-that in 1843 Audubon, the naturalist, and a party of his friends,
-came up here to find out a lot about the Western birds and animals?
-I've read a lot of Audubon, and he speaks constantly of Fort Union,
-and about the things he used to see here, and the buffalo hunting,
-and about Mr. Culbertson. Dear me! dear me! when I was reading
-about it I never thought that I would see Fort Union."
-
-"Well," said Hugh, "this is the place; and if this man Audubon was
-out here in 1843, that, I think, was just the year before they
-had the big smallpox here. Men that were here at the time tell me
-that there were two or three big camps of Indians here, and that
-they got the smallpox in the fall, just before the ground froze,
-and the Indians died off like wolves about a poisoned carcass; and
-the ground was hard, and they could not dig graves for them, and
-they just stacked up the bodies outside of the fort, in rows, like
-so much cord-wood, and had to wait till the ground melted in the
-spring before they could bury 'em. There must have been a pile of
-Indians died."
-
-"Well, what did they do for smallpox, Hugh? How did they cure
-themselves?"
-
-"Why, they didn't know anything about curing themselves, son. When
-a man got smallpox, or got sick, he just went into a sweat-lodge,
-and took a sweat, and came out and plunged into the river to cool
-off, and the ice was running, and some of 'em never came up again,
-and some of those that did come up were so weak from the shock that
-they could not get to the shore, and just drowned. If we get to the
-Blackfoot camp this summer, you ask old man Chouquette about it. He
-was here then; he'll tell you about it, just the same as he told
-me."
-
-While Hugh had been talking, the boat had cast off and had once
-more started up the river.
-
-It was afternoon, and Hugh was dozing in his chair, tilted up
-against the cabin, while Jack as usual was watching the river
-banks, when suddenly from behind a little hill that formed the end
-of a hog back, which extended well out into the bottom, he saw a
-herd of seventy or eighty buffalo, come running as hard as they
-could across the bottom, and plunge into the river just above the
-boat. The great animals ran as if frightened, and seemed to regard
-nothing but the danger behind them. As the boat went along, and
-the buffalo swam to cross the stream, they came nearer and nearer
-together, and at last it was evident that the buffalo would pass
-very close to the boat. They swam rapidly, and with them were
-many little calves, swimming on the down stream side of their
-mothers, and going swiftly and easily. Jack shouted to Hugh, who,
-with him, watched the buffalo, and in a very few minutes the boat
-was actually in the midst of the herd. The animals did not attempt
-to turn about, but swam steadily after their leaders, and some of
-them actually swam against the boat, and, only then seeming to
-understand their danger, turned about and, grunting, snorting, and
-bellowing, climbed up on each other in tremendous fright. As they
-came to the boat Jack at first had started to get his rifle, but
-Hugh called him back, and they both descended to the lower deck,
-where, with the other passengers, and the deck hands, they were
-actually within arms length of the buffalos. The mate, forming a
-noose with a rope, threw it over the head of a two-year-old, and
-half a dozen of the roustabouts, pulling on the rope, lifted the
-animal's head up on the deck, when the mate killed it, and it was
-presently hauled aboard and butchered. As they returned to the
-upper deck, having watched the buffalo, after the boat had passed,
-swim to the other bank and climb out of the water, and then stop
-and look at the boat, Jack said to Hugh, "Well, I saw a lot of
-buffalo last year, but it sort of excites one to see them again as
-close as those were."
-
-"Yes," said Hugh, "that's so; but there was no use in your getting
-your gun, as you started to. I don't want you to act like all the
-rest of these pilgrims that come up the river, and to be shooting
-at everything you see that's alive. There'd have been no more fun
-in shooting one of those buffalo in the water there, than there'd
-be in shooting a cow on the range. Of course, if a man's hungry,
-it's well enough for him to butcher; but if he just wants meat,
-and there's somebody else to do the butchering, he might just as
-well let him do it. I always used to like to hunt, and I do still,
-but it's no fun for me to kill a calf in a pen, or to chop off a
-chicken's head.
-
-"That's so, Hugh," said Jack; "it would have been no more to shoot
-one of those buffalos in the water than it was for the mate to kill
-that two-year-old."
-
-"That's so," said Hugh; "it would have been just the same thing,
-and you don't envy him the work he did, I expect."
-
-"No indeed," said Jack, "not much."
-
-"Now, if you want to fire a few shots," said Hugh, "if you want
-a little practice with your gun, get it out the next time we get
-close to the bank, and shoot at a knot in some cottonwood tree. I
-can watch with the glasses and see where you hit, and you can get
-some practice with your rifle, but won't show up a tenderfoot."
-
-The sun was low that evening when they reached Wolf Point, the
-agency for the Assinaboine Indians, and it seemed as if all
-the Indians there must have clustered about the landing-place
-to welcome the boat; men, clad in fringed buckskin shirts and
-leggings, and with eagle feathers in their hair; bright-shawled
-women, carrying babies on their backs; small boys, naked, save
-for a pair of leggings and a breech-clout; and little girls, some
-wearing handsome buckskin dresses, trimmed with elk-teeth, and
-clinging to their mothers' skirts, made up the assemblage. Most
-interesting to Jack were the many travois, each one drawn by a
-dog. Some of these were very wolf-like in appearance; others might
-have been big watch dogs taken from the front door yard of some
-eastern farm house. All seemed well-trained and patient; and when,
-a little later, some of them started off for the agency buildings,
-dragging loads that had been piled on the travois, they bent
-sturdily to their work, and dug their feet into the ground.
-
-"There's something, son," said Hugh, "that we are not going to see
-much longer. The dog travois has seen its best days, and before
-long dogs won't be used any more for that work. Why, I hear that
-even up in the North, dogs are not used in winter for hauling half
-as much as they used to be; and down here, the first thing you
-know, all these Indians will be having wagons, and driving them
-'round over the prairie. Why, do you know, it ain't so very long
-ago since these Assinaboines had hardly any horses. They didn't
-want 'em; they said horses were only a nuisance and a bother to
-'em, and their dogs were better. Horses had to be looked after;
-driven in and caught up whenever they were to be used, and then
-they had to be watched to keep people from stealing them; but dogs,
-instead of running away when you wanted to catch them, would come
-running toward you; they never ran off nor were stolen. Nowadays,
-though, the Assinaboines have got quite a good many horses, and I
-expect to live long enough to see the time when dog travois will be
-a regular curiosity."
-
-"Who are the Assinaboines, Hugh," said Jack. "What tribe are they
-related to?"
-
-"They're Sioux," said Hugh, "and talk the Sioux language. Of course
-it's a little different from that talked by the Ogallalas and the
-down river Sioux; but still they can all understand each other, and
-they call themselves Lacotah, which of course you know is the name
-that all the Sioux have for themselves."
-
-"And yet," he continued, "they have been at war with the Sioux and
-with the Sioux' friends for a good many years. I reckon there ain't
-any one that rightly knows when the Assinaboines split off from
-the main stock; it must have been a long time ago. But you talk
-with the Assinaboines, and they'll tell you--just as most of the
-other Sioux'll tell you--about a time long ago, in the lives of
-their fore-fathers, when their people lived at the edge of the salt
-water. I expect maybe that means that they migrated a long way,
-either from the East or from the West, very far back."
-
-"My!" said Jack, "if we could only know about all these things that
-happened, and what the history of each tribe was, wouldn't it be
-interesting?"
-
-"It sure would," said Hugh.
-
-"Well, Hugh," continued Jack, "what does Assinaboine mean? Has it
-any real meaning, like some of these other names of Indian tribes
-that you tell me about?"
-
-"Yes," said Hugh, "it has a meaning, and I reckon it's a Cree word.
-_Ass[)i]ne_ means stone in Cree, _poit_ means cooked, or cooking,
-and the Assinaboines are called stone-cookers, or stone-roasters,
-I suppose because they used to do their cooking with hot stones.
-But of course that don't mean much, because pretty nearly all the
-Indians that I know of used to boil their meat with hot rocks,
-except those that made pots and kettles for themselves out of clay.
-Nobody knows, I reckon, when the Pawnees and Mandans first learned
-how to make pots. I expect that was a long time ago, too. But most
-of these Indians used to boil meat in a kettle made of hide, or the
-paunch of a buffalo, filled with water. Then they'd heat stones in
-the fire, and put them in the water, taking them out as they got
-cool and putting in others, until the water boiled and the food was
-cooked."
-
-"But," said Jack, "I should think when they cooked the hide or
-paunch it would break, and let the water spill out."
-
-"No," said Hugh. "It would of course, if you kept cooking long
-enough; but one of these kettles would only last to cook a single
-meal; you couldn't use it a second time, but it was all right for
-one cooking. I have seen a hide kettle used, and eaten from it."
-
-Jack sat thinking, for awhile, and then he turned to Hugh and said:
-
-"I tell you, Hugh, if all you know about Indians, and about this
-Western country were put in a book, it would make an awful big one,
-wouldn't it?"
-
-"Well, I don't know, son," said Hugh, "maybe it might; but a man
-has got to learn the life he's lived; if he doesn't, he won't
-amount to nothing. I expect if all that you know about the East was
-put in a book it would make quite a sizable one."
-
-"Oh," said Jack, "that's nothing. The things I know don't amount to
-anything, and everybody else knows them a good deal better than I
-do."
-
-"Well, I tell you," said Hugh, "the things that are new and strange
-to you seem kind o' wonderful, but they don't seem wonderful to
-me; but I remember one time you were telling me something about
-catching fish down at the place called Great South Bay, and talking
-about seeing the vessels sailing on the ocean, and to me that
-seemed mighty wonderful."
-
-By this time the boat had left the landing-place, and the light was
-growing dim. They turned and looked back, and there across the wide
-bottom was moving toward the Post, a long string of people, men and
-women and children and dog travois, so that it looked almost like
-a moving camp. Hugh and Jack sat for a while longer on the deck
-talking, and then, as the mosquitoes got bad, they turned in.
-
-The next afternoon the boat reached Fort Peck, then one of the
-most important Indian agencies on the Missouri River. It stood
-on a narrow bench, a few log buildings surrounded by a stockade,
-and back of it the bluffs rose sharply, and were dotted with
-the scaffolds of the dead. It seemed to Jack that there must be
-hundreds and hundreds, if not thousands, of these graves in sight.
-From the poles of some of them long streamers were blown out in the
-wind, which Hugh told him were offerings tied to the poles of the
-scaffolds by mourning relatives. But few living Indians were seen
-here, and there were only three or four white men seen about the
-trading post. They did not leave the boat, which soon pushed on
-again.
-
-"The Indians about here have been awful mean," said Hugh; "Lots of
-things were brought in here that the Sioux took from the Custer
-battlefield. Somebody told me that Custer's gold watch was brought
-in here by an Indian, who wanted to know how much it was worth:
-but so many questions were asked him about it that he just put the
-watch in his sack and lit out, and has not been seen here since."
-
-As the boat passed the mouth of the Musselshell early next morning
-Hugh pointed shoreward, and said:
-
-"Do you see that place over there where that creek comes in, son?"
-
-"Why, of course I see it, Hugh," said Jack, "and the timber that
-runs along it. What creek is it?"
-
-"You ought to know," said Hugh, with a laugh; "you got scared in it
-a whole lot last summer."
-
-"Why, Hugh, is that the Musselshell?" said Jack.
-
-"That's what it is," said Hugh; "and seeing the mouth of the river,
-and them sticks there on the flat, reminds me of the big fight
-that took place there some years back. I wonder if you ever heard
-about it. I meant to tell you last summer, but somehow it slipped
-my mind. It was there that Liver-Eating Johnson got his name. They
-used to say that he cut out the liver of an Indian that got killed
-in that fight and ate it. Of course he never did, but they tell the
-story about him, and I rather think he was kind o' proud about it
-after a little while, and liked the name.
-
-"I think it was in 1869 that the fight took place, along in the
-spring.
-
-"You know the steamboats always have trouble in coming up to
-Benton in the low water; and along about 1866, after the mines got
-paying, and when the fur trade was good, some men at Helena formed
-a company to make a road and start a freight line down to some
-point on the river that the boats could always get to. These men
-didn't know much about the river, and they chose the mouth of the
-Musselshell for the point where their road, which began at Helena,
-should end.
-
-"Now, I suppose if they'd raked the whole river with a fine-tooth
-comb they couldn't have found a poorer place for a town, nor a
-poorer country to travel through, than this one they pitched on.
-The place chosen for the town was that little neck of land between
-the Musselshell and the Missouri. The soil is a bad-land clay,
-which in summer is an alkali desert, and in spring is a regular
-bog, in which a saddle-blanket would mire down. Then, all along
-the Musselshell was a favorite camping and hunting ground for the
-Indians, and in those days Indians were bad. Well, they made up
-their company, and started their town. There weren't many settlers,
-but a few people, mostly hunters and wood-choppers, stopped there;
-and of course, wherever there were a few people gathered together,
-there was sure to be a store and a few saloons.
-
-"I think it was along in 1868 that a man came down there with a
-fine train of mules. Likely he expected to get some freighting to
-do when the boats came up the river. The stock was turned out, and
-some men were on guard, when a party of Sioux charged in among
-them, killed two of the men, and ran off every hoof of stock. The
-thing was done in a minute; and before the men could get out of
-their houses and tents the stock was gone, and the Indians along
-with it: all except one young fellow, who, just to show what he
-could do, charged back and rode through the crowd, making fun of
-them as he went along. So far as anybody knew, not one Indian got
-hit.
-
-"It was not very long after that that the Sioux came down and
-charged into the Crow camp, and ran off eight hundred head of
-horses. Of course that made a big excitement. The Crows jumped on
-their horses an pursued and they had quite a fight, and some of the
-Indians got killed.
-
-"During the Spring of 1869, the Indians used to attack the town
-every few days; a Crow squaw that was living there got shot through
-the body, and a white woman was wounded, knocked down, and scalped,
-but I reckon she's living yet. Anybody that went out any distance
-from the town was sure to be shot at and chased. It was a time for
-a man to travel 'round with his gun loaded, and in his hand all the
-time. The Indians didn't do much of anything, but they kept the
-people scared up everlastingly. It got to be so, finally, that the
-Indians would charge down near the town, and then swing off and run
-away, and pretty much all the men would run out and run after them,
-shooting as long as the Indians were in sight.
-
-"One morning there were a couple of Crow women out a little way
-from town, gathering sage brush for wood, and the Indians opened
-fire on them. The white men all rushed out and after the Indians,
-who numbered sixteen. They ran on foot over toward the Musselshell,
-and then up the bottom, not going very fast, and the white men
-were gaining on them, and thinking that now they would force
-them to a regular fight; when suddenly, from a ravine on the
-Musselshell, a shot was fired, which killed a man named Leader.
-
-"That stopped the whites right off, and they turned to run; and if
-the Indians had charged 'em then, I expect they'd have got every
-last one of 'em. But Henry McDonald saw what would happen if they
-ran, and, bringing down his rifle, swore he'd shoot the first man
-who went faster than a walk.
-
-"They could see now that there was quite a body of Indians in the
-ravine on the bank of the Musselshell, but they couldn't tell how
-many. There was some little shooting between the two parties. Most
-of the whites moved back to the settlement; but there were half
-a dozen men who did not retreat; but getting under cover, within
-thirty or forty yards of the Indians, held them there. They kept
-shooting, back and forth, and presently a man named Greenwood got
-shot through the lungs, and had to be carried back. The other men
-stood their ground, and the Indians, knowing that they had to do
-with good shots, did not dare to show their heads.
-
-"After two or three hours of this sort of thing, it began to rain,
-a mighty lucky thing for the white men. They were all armed with
-Henry rifles, or needle-guns, while the Indians, for the most part,
-had bows and arrows, with some flintlock guns. They had stripped
-themselves for war, and had no clothing with which they could
-cover their gun-locks and bow-strings to keep them from getting
-wet. After a little of this, the white men began to see that
-the Indians were practically disarmed, and began to think about
-charging them; but when they raised up to look, they saw that there
-was a big party of men there, and that the only way to get them,
-except in a hand to hand fight, was for some of the party to cross
-the Musselshell, and get to a point where they could shoot into the
-ravine, thus driving the Indians out and placing them between two
-fires. Three men started to do this.
-
-"When the Indians saw what the white men were trying to do, they
-ran down to the mouth of the ravine and tried to shoot at them;
-but their strings were wet, and the arrows had no force and hardly
-reached the men, and very few of their guns would go off. The
-three men got across the river, and went down to a point opposite
-the ravine, and began to shoot at the Indians; but by this time
-all the men in the settlement had collected together, about eight
-hundred yards behind the Indians, and seeing these three men on
-the other side of the stream took them for Indians and began to
-shoot at them; so that the three white men who had crossed had to
-get away and re-cross the Musselshell. By this time half a dozen
-other men got around on the lower side of the Indians, and then
-again three men crossed the river and commenced to shoot up the
-ravine. This was too much for the Indians: they jumped out of
-their hole and started to get away, and everybody was shooting at
-them as hard as they could. The fire from the body of men near the
-town still continued, and obliged the men who were doing the real
-fighting to keep more or less under cover. The Indians broke for
-the Musselshell, crossing it where they could, and most of them got
-away; but thirteen were killed, and it was said that a good many
-more died on the way to camp, and only one of the ninety and more
-who were in the fight escaped without a wound. The next day after
-that, the white men found the place where the Indians had stripped
-for the fight and left their things, and there over a hundred robes
-and two war bonnets and a whole lot of other stuff were found. Most
-of it was sold, and the money given to Greenwood, who was wounded.
-Jim Wells and Henry McDonald, I heard, each got a war bonnet.
-
-"The freight road was given up, and pretty much everybody left the
-place,--except some traders who stopped there a little longer. Then
-Carroll was started, up near the Little Rockies, and in a very much
-better place, and that was the end of Musselshell City. It was at
-this same place that Johnson claimed to have made for himself a
-razor strap from a strip of skin that he cut from an Indian's back:
-but Johnson was always a good man to tell stories, and you never
-could be quite sure when he was telling the truth and when he was
-joking.
-
-"A few years ago there used to be lots of talk about that fight,
-and the people called it one of the biggest lickings that the
-Indians ever got in this part of the country."
-
-Pushing along up the river, the boat passed beyond the Musselshell,
-and then up by Carroll, and the Little Rocky Mountain, and the
-Bearspaw,--and at last one day, about noon, Fort Benton came in
-sight.
-
-For the last two hundred miles they had seen a good deal of
-game. Buffalo were almost always in sight on the bluffs, or in
-the bottom; elk, frightened by the approach of the steamer, tore
-through the willow points; deer, both black-tail and white-tail,
-were often seen, and on several occasions mountain sheep were
-viewed--once in the bottom and at other times on the high bad-land
-bluffs. One of the herds was a large one, which Hugh said must
-contain seventy-five or a hundred animals.
-
-As Benton was approached, Jack began to feel more and more excited.
-Here he hoped to meet Joe, who had been warned some months before
-by Mr. Sturgis that Hugh and Jack would be at Benton early in July:
-and Joe would have with him the horses, a lodge, and all their
-camp equipage; so that, if nothing interfered to prevent, the next
-morning they could start out on their trip.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER III
-
-FOR THE BLACKFOOT CAMP
-
-
-As the boat slowly drew near the wharf, Hugh and Jack, from the
-upper deck, recognized first the old adobe fort and then, one after
-another, the different buildings of the town. The arrival of the
-steamer was always a great event in Benton, and pretty much all
-the inhabitants of the town were seen making their way toward the
-water's edge. The throng was made up of whites and Indians, with an
-occasional Chinaman: for already Chinamen had begun to come into
-the country. At first the two watchers from the steamboat could
-recognize no faces, but, as the boat drew nearer and nearer, Hugh
-suddenly let his hand fall on Jack's shoulder and said, "There's
-Baptiste, and I believe that's Joe standing near him."
-
-"Oh, where are they, Hugh? I can't see either of them:" and then a
-moment later, after Hugh had told him where the two stood, he saw
-them; and springing up on the rail, and holding to a stanchion, he
-waved his hat, and shouted out to Joe, who had already recognized
-him and made joyous gestures in response.
-
-A little later, the four were cordially shaking hands on the shore:
-and presently, when the crowd of passengers had left the boat, the
-two old men and the boys went on board again and, mounting to the
-upper deck, talked together. Jack's first question to Joe was as to
-the whereabouts of the camp.
-
-"Down east of the Judith Mountains somewhere, I expect," said Joe
-in reply. "They went down there to kill buffalo; there's lots
-of buffalo over on the Judith, or between the Judith and the
-Musselshell. I guess they'll be there all summer, and before I left
-the camp I heard that they would make the medicine lodge somewhere
-out in that country."
-
-"What about the hostiles, Joe?" said Jack. "Have they seen any
-Sioux lately?"
-
-"No," said Joe, "but I've heard that there are a few passing back
-and forth, between the lower country and Sitting Bull's camp, over
-across the line."
-
-"Like enough," said Hugh, "like enough. We've got to look out for
-those fellows; but they won't do nothing more than try to steal our
-horses."
-
-Hugh had been talking quietly with Baptiste La Jeunesse, who told
-him what had been happening in Benton during the winter. This was
-not much: there was talk that a railroad was going to be built into
-the country, one that might even pass through Fort Benton itself,
-and this would make the town big and important, so people said--and
-Fort Benton would once more become what it had been in the early
-days of the fur trade, a populous and thriving place.
-
-"And how have you been getting on yourself, Bat?" said Hugh.
-
-"Oh, I've done well. I always have everything that I want, since
-you people came in here last summer and gave me the gold. Every
-month I go to the bank, and they give me the pay for the money
-that you lent them for me, and so I live well. It doesn't make any
-difference to me whether I've work to do or not, yet always it is
-pleasant to be doing something, and so I keep on working. Also,
-there are some people in the town who are poor, just as I used to
-be; and now that I have money I can help them to live, just as your
-boy has helped me."
-
-"Well, Bat, it makes me feel good that you are doing well, and I
-think that you will continue to do well from this on."
-
-"And what are you going to do this season, Hugh?" said Baptiste.
-"Where are you going, and what are you going to do--hunting or
-trapping, or what?"
-
-"Well, Bat," said Hugh, "I am traveling 'round again with this boy
-of mine. His uncle and his father and mother want him to spend the
-summers out here, and get strong and hearty, and they've told me to
-travel with him, and teach him about the way of living out here;
-the same lesson that you and I learned when we were young; only he
-will learn it in a better and easier way than we did. He's a good
-boy: I like him better all the time. I should feel bad if anything
-happened to him."
-
-"Yes, Hugh, I think he's a good boy," said Baptiste. "Both of those
-boys are good. I like the Indian well. He came in here many days
-ago, and came to me; and since he got here, he and I have lived
-together. I like him."
-
-Hugh now turned to the two boys, who were busily talking, and
-said; "Now, boys, if we're going to get off to-night we've got to
-make a start right soon. I expect Joe has got all our stuff ready,
-except the grub, and if you and he will hurry up and get the horses
-together and get them saddled, I'll go and buy the grub, and put
-it in the wagon, and come down here and get our guns and beds, and
-we'll pack up and move out of town four or five miles and camp."
-
-Both the boys jumped to their feet, and Jack said; "Hurray! that's
-what I want to do; I want to get out on the prairie once more, and
-I don't want to see a town again until I have to."
-
-Jack and Joe started at once, and ran races with each other up the
-street, to see which should get first to the stable. Joe beat the
-white boy, who found that his winter's confinement, and his lack
-of exercise in the big city had made him short of wind; so that at
-last he got out of breath, and stopped running. When they reached
-the stable, Joe took his rope and went out into the corral, and
-caught a handsome little buckskin pony, and, saddling it, rode
-out to get the animals which were pasturing on the bluffs above
-the town. He was gone some little time, and then, Jack, who was
-watching for him, saw the familiar sight of loose horses running
-along the bluff, and then turning and rushing down its steep sides,
-followed by a cloud of dust; and then Joe, with whoops and yells,
-and quick turnings and twistings of his horse, drove them up to
-the bars, through which they crowded, and then stood quiet in the
-corral.
-
-Jack thought that he would try his old scheme of calling Pawnee,
-and whistled sharply. The good horse threw up his head, and looked
-about, and then seeming to recognize Jack, walked over to him, and
-arched his neck over his shoulder in the old-fashioned way. Jack
-was very much touched, and put his arms around the horse's head,
-and leaned his head against his neck, thrilled with affection for
-the animal that he had ridden so many miles. Presently they got
-out the ropes, and tied up the horses, and one by one they were
-saddled. They were all fat and in good condition, and some of them
-objected quite strongly to being saddled. The dun bucked when the
-flank cinch tightened on him, just as he had bucked the first time
-Jack ever saw him packed, and so did the star-faced bay. The others
-grunted and squealed and kicked a little, but on the whole took the
-saddling very well.
-
-Not long after they had finished saddling up they heard a cheery
-call from the front of the stable, and, rushing out, Jack saw the
-wagon, piled up with food and beds, and Hugh and Baptiste, sitting
-in it. It took some little time to make up the packs, but by late
-afternoon this was done, the horses packed, and after shaking
-hands with Baptiste, the little train, with Hugh in the lead, Jack
-driving three pack horses, and Joe bringing up the rear, driving
-two more, filed out of the town and climbed the hills toward the
-upper prairie.
-
-That afternoon they traveled until the sun went down, and then
-coming on a little coulee, through which water trickled, they
-camped. They were careful to picket all their horses; and after
-this was done, while Joe and Jack brought armfuls of willow brush
-from up and down the creek, Hugh cooked supper.
-
-The next day they kept on. Now they were well away from the
-settlements, and game began to be seen. Only antelope, it is true,
-but of them there were plenty. Jack had a fair shot at a buck, at
-about a hundred and twenty-five yards, but failed to kill him--to
-his great mortification.
-
-"Ha!" said Hugh, "you've got to learn how to shoot again; you shot
-too high, and missed him slick and clean. I remember the first shot
-you fired last year, when you first came out; you shot high then,
-just as you did now. When we get to camp to-night, you and Joe had
-better go out and shoot three or four times at a mark. You have got
-to learn your gun over again, and Joe of course has got to learn
-his for the first time." Jack had brought out from New York a gun
-for Joe, carefully selected from the stock of one of the largest
-rifle manufacturers in the world, and as yet Joe had not fired a
-shot out of it; but he seemed never to tire of looking at it, and
-putting it up to his shoulder, and sighting at various objects.
-That night they camped on a great swiftly rushing stream, near some
-high hills, or low mountains; and while he was cooking supper Hugh
-sent them off to try their guns. With the axe they shaved off the
-outer bark from a thick cottonwood tree, and making a black mark on
-the brown surface, each fired five shots at it. Jack's first two
-shots were high, but the next three were clustered within the size
-of a silver dollar, all about the mark. Joe did not shoot quite so
-steadily, two of his shots being above, and two below, and one a
-little off to one side. When they returned to camp and Hugh asked
-them about their shooting, they told him, and he advised them to
-fire a few more shots after supper, and, if necessary, a few in the
-morning.
-
-"There's nothing, I hate worse than to hear a gun fired about
-camp," he said, "but guns are no use to people unless they
-understand them, and you boys must get used to your guns. It won't
-take you more than a very few shots to do this, and you certainly
-must do it."
-
-The next morning they started on again. No signs had yet been seen
-of the Indians, but this day they saw a few buffalo, old bulls,
-mostly off to the north of them. In the afternoon they passed by
-the Moccasin Mountains, and camped on a little stream flowing into
-the Judith River. After they had unpacked their animals and made
-camp, Hugh said to Jack, "Son, have you ever been here before? Do
-you see anything that you recognize?"
-
-"Why, no Hugh," said Jack, "I don't think I do;" and standing up
-he took a long look about him, up and down the valley, and at the
-hills on either side. Suddenly his face brightened, and he said,
-"Why yes I do, too. I know where we are. This is just where we
-came through last year, the second day after I got caught in the
-quicksands in the Musselshell."
-
-"That's so," said Hugh, "this is just where we came. I wondered if
-you'd recognize it. You ought to do so, and I'm glad you do.
-
-"Right over a few miles east of us is what we used to call old
-Camp Lewis. There used to be a trading store there, and a camp
-of soldiers, and a few men got killed there, mostly soldiers. I
-remember coming through here not many years ago, the afternoon
-after some soldiers got killed on the bank of the creek, right
-close to the camp. There was a camp of Crows there then--about
-three hundred lodges. The Sioux came down, and ran off some
-government horses, and killed three recruits that were fishing here
-in the creek, and the Crows took after 'em, and had quite a fight,
-and Long Horse, the Crow chief got killed. They got seven of the
-Sioux, I think. They had quite a time here in the camp then. I
-remember Yellowstone Kelly was here, and three or four other men; I
-think the Sioux set them all afoot."
-
-The next morning while Hugh was getting breakfast he said to Jack:
-"Son, why don't you kill some meat? You are going through a country
-where game is fairly plenty; anyway, antelope are, and there's a
-few buffalo; and besides that, here are some mountains right close
-to you, where there's surely lots of sheep. You boys had better
-make up your minds to do something to-day; if you don't I'll have
-to start out and hunt, to kill meat for the camp."
-
-"Well, Hugh," said Jack, "I certainly would rather hunt than
-drive pack horses; and if you want me to I'll go off to-day and
-follow along a little closer to the hills, and see if I can't kill
-something."
-
-"Do so," said Hugh, "and then if you kill anything you can easily
-overtake us. We will be traveling slow, and your horse is good and
-fat and can catch us wherever we are. All the same, keep your eye
-open for Indians, and don't let any strangers come up too close to
-you. I'd rather have you two boys go off together, but I've got to
-keep Joe with me, to drive these pack horses. You'd better throw
-the saddle on your horse and start right off, and maybe you'll
-catch us before we've gone very far."
-
-No sooner said than done. Jack saddled up, and having asked Hugh
-the direction in which the party would move, rode away to the left,
-toward the low foot-hills of the mountains. He had gone only a mile
-or two when, passing over the shoulder of the foot-hills, he found
-himself coming down into a narrow valley, in which pretty little
-meadows were interspersed with clumps of cottonwoods and willows.
-Three or four antelope were feeding in the valley not far off, but
-there was no cover under which they could be approached, so he
-rode straight along. As he drew near, the antelope ceased feeding
-and raised their heads, and then, before he was within easy rifle
-shot, trotted off to the other side of the valley, and stood on
-the hillside watching him. After looking back for a few moments,
-they started, in single file, and slowly walked up the hill. They
-were by no means frightened, and it seemed likely that by taking a
-little time, after they had passed on out of sight, he might get a
-shot at them; but the brush above him on the stream seemed likely
-to hold a deer, and he turned his horse that way and rode quietly
-forward up the stream, among the groups of bushes. He had not
-gone very far when from a clump of willows at his right a big doe
-sprang into view, and moved slowly off by those high, long bounds
-which make the white-tail, in motion, one of the most graceful of
-animals. Jack's impulse was to jump off his horse and shoot at
-her, but he saw that, if he did this, he would be so low down that
-she could hardly be seen over the tops of the willows. He checked
-Pawnee, cocked his gun, and rising a little in his stirrups, and
-gripping the horse with his thighs, aimed carefully at the back of
-the doe's head, just as she was rising in one of her leaps, and
-pulled the trigger.
-
-Almost at the report, her long tail fell flat to her body, and
-she began to run much faster. He knew he had hit her, and before
-she had gone fifty yards, and while she was crossing an open bit
-of meadow, she fell. Jack rode up to her, and on turning her over
-found that he had made a good shot. A ball had entered her back,
-just to the right of the spine, and had pierced both lungs and
-heart.
-
-Turning her over, to get her ready to put on the horse, he was
-glad to see that she was a barren doe, one that had not produced
-a fawn that spring, and so would be fat and good eating. She was
-pretty big, however, and Jack was a little uncertain just how he
-was going to get her on his horse. Of course by cutting her up it
-could easily have been done, for then the quarters would not be
-too heavy for him to handle. At first he thought that he would
-take in the whole animal, but considering the time that this
-might take, and the fact that he had to ride a long way before
-overtaking his companions, he determined to do things in the easier
-way. He skinned the deer, therefore, cut off the shoulders and
-hams, and tied them on his horse, and then taking out sirloins and
-tenderloins, and some of the fat, wrapped this up in the skin, and
-put that on behind the saddle. Now he had a fairly compact load,
-which could be easily carried, and would not be a great additional
-weight for his horse; while on the ground were left all the bones
-of the deer, except those of the legs. This method of butchering he
-had learned from the Indians the summer before.
-
-All this had taken some little time, and when Jack looked at the
-sun he saw that the morning was half gone. Hugh had told him that
-they would follow the trail around the point of the mountains, and
-would then strike the Carroll Road, and bend back toward the river
-again. This meant that if he could cross the point of the mountains
-he would save several miles travel, and this he determined to do.
-
-Before starting, he tightened up his cinches carefully, for he knew
-that the pieces of meat tied on his saddle would give it more or
-less side motion, and he did not want it to chafe Pawnee's back.
-Then he climbed into the saddle and started. By this time the sun
-was pouring down hot upon him, and there was no breeze. From the
-high ridges that he crossed from time to time he had a wide view
-of the prairie, and of the distant mountains, the Little Belts
-and Snowies, which rose from the plain a long way to the south.
-Here and there on the prairie were black dots, which he knew were
-buffalo, and other white ones, much nearer, which were antelope.
-Occasionally, as he rode along, a great sage grouse would rise from
-the ground near his horse's feet, or a jack-rabbit would start up,
-and after running fifteen or twenty yards, would stop, sit up,
-raise its enormous ears, look at him for a moment, and then settle
-back on all fours, and flatten itself on the ground, so that if he
-took his eye off it for a moment he could not find it again. It
-seemed to him then, as it had so often seemed before, a wonderful
-thing to see how absolutely this wild creature, like so many
-others, could disappear from sight even while one was looking at it.
-
-As he rode over a high ridge, he saw on the hillside before him,
-two white-rumped animals, that for a moment he thought were
-antelope; but a second glance showed him that they were not, and,
-to his very great astonishment, he recognized them as mountain
-sheep--a ewe and her young one--which had been feeding on the
-prairie, just where he would have expected an antelope to be. He
-threw himself off his horse and, cocking his gun, jerked it to
-his shoulder and then paused, and lowering it again, stepped back
-and put his foot in the stirrup. As he mounted, the ewe, which
-had been looking at him, started to run, passing hardly more than
-fifty yards in front of him, closely followed by the lamb. A little
-further on, she stopped again and gazed, and Jack sat there and
-returned her look. The sight of the sheep had been almost too much
-for him, and he had come near shooting her,--but before he pressed
-the trigger he realized that if he shot her he should have to shoot
-the lamb, and he could not conveniently carry either, and the old
-ewe would be thin in flesh and hardly worth taking with him. The
-temptation had been strong, but as he sat there and looked at the
-graceful animal, which stood and stamped, while the lamb, close
-beside her, imitated her motions, he realized that it was a good
-thing to let them go.
-
-It seemed to him a mysterious thing, though, that these sheep
-should be down here on the prairie, and a long way from the rocky
-peaks, where he supposed they always lived. He made up his mind
-that he would ask Hugh about this when he got into camp and get him
-to explain it.
-
-At last he had crossed the point of the mountains and began to
-descend. Stretching out toward the northeast he could see a dim
-thin line, which, although it was interrupted at times--and
-sometimes for long distances--he thought must be the Carroll Road.
-Then off a long way to the east was a line of dark--the timber
-along a stream's course--which he supposed was where they would
-camp to-night.
-
-He had almost reached the level prairie, when suddenly he became
-aware of two horsemen galloping toward him from behind. He watched
-them as they drew nearer, and at last could make out that they were
-Indians; and by this is meant that he saw that they had no hats on.
-More than that, he could see, he thought, that one of them had red
-leggings.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER IV
-
-OLD FRIENDS AND NEW
-
-
-Of course there were no known hostiles in the country, but at the
-same time he recalled Hugh's advice, not to let any Indians come
-too close to him. These men were galloping along and would soon
-overtake him; and if, by any chance they should happen to be Sioux,
-from Sitting Bull's camp, or worthless Indians of any tribe that
-he did not know, they might take his horse and gun, even if they
-did nothing worse. He decided then that he would find out who they
-were, and drawing up his horse on a little rise of ground, he
-dismounted and stood behind it, facing them with his rifle barrel
-resting in the saddle. The Indians were now only three or four
-hundred yards off, but when Jack did this they at once halted, and
-turning toward each other, seemed to consult. Then, one of them,
-raising his hands high in the air, held his gun above his head, and
-after handing it over to his companion, struck his horse with his
-quirt and galloped toward Jack, while the other man remained where
-he was.
-
-The swift little pony was soon within easy rifle shot, and as its
-rider drew nearer and nearer, Jack seemed to recognize something
-familiar in the look of the man, yet he could hardly tell what it
-was; but when he was within speaking distance the man called out;
-"Why, don't you know me, Master Jack? I'm Hezekiah;" and instantly
-Jack recognized his negro friend of the Blackfoot camp. He called
-back to him; "Hello, Hezekiah! come on; I didn't know who you
-were." And Hezekiah, turning about, waved to his companion, who
-started toward them.
-
-Jack and Hezekiah shook hands, and Hezekiah said; "You done mighty
-well to stop us, Master Jack; you're making a good prairie man all
-right, and I'm glad to see it. Plenty Indians traveling through
-this country, back and forth, that would be willing to kill you for
-your horse and gun; and it ain't far off to the line, and they'd
-skip across and go to Sitting Bull's camp, and nobody'd ever know
-who done it. It's just like what all the Piegans said last year,
-after the Medicine Lodge, that you was sure goin' to make a good
-warrior."
-
-"Well Hezekiah," said Jack, "I don't know as I'd have stopped you
-if Hugh hadn't spoken to me about that only this morning. He said
-that there were Sioux traveling back and forth, and that I had
-better not let any Indians come up close to me until I knew who
-they were. That's the reason I stopped you." At this moment the
-other Indian rode up, and handing his gun to Hezekiah, shook hands
-cordially with Jack. It was Bull Calf, one of his companions on
-the trip to the Grassy Lakes, where Jack had shot the Assinaboine
-who was trying to steal horses from the camp; a young man of good
-family whom he knew very well, and with whom he had been on several
-hunting excursions.
-
-"Where's the camp Hezekiah?" asked Jack. "Hugh and Joe have gone
-on ahead with the pack train, and I stopped behind to kill a deer.
-We're looking for your camp, and going to stay a little while with
-you, and then we're going off south into the mountains."
-
-"The camp isn't far off Master Jack," said Hezekiah. "I expect it's
-right over there on Muddy Creek; somewhere in that timber. Some
-days ago they left Carroll, and are moving south now after buffalo;
-but Bull Calf, here, and me, we came 'round by the mountains here,
-to see if we couldn't kill some sheep. I want to get a couple of
-shirts made, and my woman says she'd rather make 'em of sheep than
-of antelope.
-
-"I expect we'll strike the camp this afternoon somewhere and maybe
-we'd better be starting right along now." They mounted, and rode
-on over the prairie. Jack had many questions to ask about what had
-happened in the Piegan camp during the winter, for though Joe had
-told him much, there were still plenty of matters to be discussed.
-Hezekiah and Bull Calf wanted to ride fast, but Jack did not feel
-like doing so with his load, so he put the two shoulders of the
-deer on Bull Calf's horse, and tied down what he carried so that
-it would not shake, and they went on at a good pace. An hour or
-two of brisk riding brought them close to the stream; but before
-they reached it they saw the trail where the camp had passed. There
-were tracks of a great band of horses, and many scratches left by
-travois poles; and in the trail there were a number of fresher
-horse tracks, which showed where Hugh and Joe and the pack animals
-had passed along after the camp.
-
-Jack had a feeling as if he were almost home. It seemed funny to
-him to think how eager he was to meet all the brown-skinned friends
-that he had left so many months before, and how much pleasure he
-felt in having come across these two on the prairie. Two hours
-before sundown they began to see horses dotted over the hills ahead
-of them; and a little later they rode out into a broad open space
-in the river bottom, where stood a circle of white lodges, which
-they knew was the Piegan camp.
-
-"Where do you suppose Hugh will camp, Hezekiah?" said Jack, as
-he ran his eye over the lodges, each one of which looked like
-every other lodge. It was evident that he could tell nothing by
-looking at the lodges, and he must look for the horses; and just as
-Hezekiah replied, he thought he saw old Baldy tied in front of a
-lodge on the opposite side of the circle.
-
-"Why, I reckon he'll camp with Joe's people, Master Jack," said
-Hezekiah. "That's the Fat Roasters, you know, and they're over
-there across the circle. I reckon that's the old man now, drivin'
-pins for the lodge."
-
-"Yes, that's it, Hezekiah," said Jack: "I see him now. I'll ride
-over there and get rid of my meat, and sometime to-night or
-to-morrow I hope to come to your lodge."
-
-"Please do, Master Jack, and we'll be mighty glad to see you. I
-want to have you see the childern, too; they've grown a heap since
-you was here last."
-
-As Jack stopped in front of the lodge, Hugh looked up from his task
-and said, "Well, you've got here all right, son. Killed somethin'
-too, I reckon."
-
-"Yes," said Jack, "I killed a barren doe, and I reckon we've got
-meat enough to keep us going for a few days. I gave the shoulders
-to Bull Calf and Hezekiah, whom I met out here on the prairie, but
-I've got the hams here. Shall I turn Pawnee loose, or shall I tie
-him up here by old Baldy?"
-
-"Better tie him up here," said Hugh. "I want to make arrangements
-with some young fellow to herd our horses; Joe's gone off now to
-try to do that. We've got the lodge up, and now pretty quick we'll
-have a fire and cook supper."
-
-The news of the arrival of the strangers had already spread through
-the camp, and that night Hugh and Jack and Joe were invited to
-feasts at several lodges. They saw many of their friends: old John
-Monroe, Little Plume, Last Bull, and of course Fox Eye, and many
-others. Old Iron Shirt came around to their lodge, and shook hands
-cordially with Jack, from whom he accepted a plug of tobacco and
-a red silk handkerchief. It was late before the festivities were
-over, and when they turned into their blankets they were soon
-asleep.
-
-While they were at breakfast next morning, Jack told Hugh about the
-sheep that he had seen on the prairie the day before, and how he
-had been about to kill the old ewe, and then had thought it better
-not to do so.
-
-"You did just right, son," said Hugh; "I've said to you a good many
-times never to kill anything that you don't want, and can't use,
-and I believe that's the way to do. You were right not to kill the
-old ewe also because she wouldn't have been good for anything;
-she'd have been poor from suckling her lamb, and you'd have just
-killed her without getting any good out of it. Besides that, the
-lamb would have starved to death if you hadn't killed it, and if
-you had killed it it would'nt have been no good. No, you did right;
-you used good sense, and I like men, or boys either, to use sense."
-
-"Well, Hugh, I'm glad I didn't shoot. Of course, maybe I wouldn't
-have killed the ewe anyhow, but I'd have tried. But what I wanted
-to ask you about was what those sheep were doing down there on the
-prairie. I supposed that sheep only lived on high mountains, or
-else in the very roughest kind of bad-lands. They're called Rocky
-Mountain sheep; that ought to mean that they live in the Rocky
-Mountains."
-
-"Well now, son, you're like a good many people that think that
-sheep ain't found anywhere except in the mountains, but that's a
-big mistake. In old times sheep were found on the prairie just
-about as much as they were found in the mountains. I expect they
-were always in the mountains, and in old times they were always
-on the prairie too. It has got so now that they're pretty scarce
-on the prairie, because so many people traveling around all the
-time shoot at them; but in old times it was no uncommon sight to
-see sheep feeding right in among the buffalo, and we often used
-to see them all mixed up with the antelope, on the flat prairie.
-Of course, sheep always like to be somewhere within reach of the
-buttes or mountains, or rough bad-lands, that they can run to if
-they get scared, but as for them not being on the prairie, the
-way some people think, that's all a mistake. Up here in Montana,
-and in Dakota and Nebraska and Wyoming, I have seen them on the
-prairie, a long way from any hills. Why, I've even seen them out in
-the sand-hills, up not very far from the head of the Dismal River,
-and south of the Loup, but I suppose they came from up the Platte,
-where there are bad-lands and buttes, like Scott's Bluffs and
-Chimney Rock. But if ever people tell you that sheep are found only
-among the rocks, don't you believe them. I know you won't after
-to-day, because you saw them on the prairie yourself."
-
-"Yes, Hugh, that's so; but just as you say, they started to run
-back to the rocks when they were scared."
-
-"Why son, there's no better sheep country in America to-day, I
-believe, than within a day's ride of here. You take the Missouri
-River bad-lands, and the Little Rockies, the Judith Mountains, the
-Little Belts, the Moccasins, and the Bear's Paw; they're all good
-sheep countries, and always have been ever since I've been in the
-country; and I reckon if you ask any of the old Indians they'll
-tell you just the same thing. Why, years and years ago, before the
-Indians got bad, there was no place where there were more mountain
-sheep than right along the Yellowstone, where the bluffs don't run
-more than a couple of hundred feet high, and there's a flat bottom
-below them, and just rolling prairie above."
-
-"Well, I didn't know this at all, Hugh," said Jack, "and yesterday
-when I saw those animals on that little ridge, I could not believe
-that they were sheep. I thought I must be mistaken, that they must
-be queer colored antelope, but then of course I saw the sheep horns
-and I knew that I wasn't mistaken."
-
-"There's lots to learn about sheep yet, son; and you and I are not
-the only people that don't know much about them. The fact is, I
-don't believe anybody knows much about them.
-
-"I expect there's more than one kind of sheep in the country, too.
-I have heard about a white sheep that they find away up north; and
-then a great many years ago, once when I went up north to Peace
-River, I killed a sheep that was pretty nearly black, and had black
-horns. I never saw but one little bunch of them, and killed one out
-of it, a yearling ewe; she was not like any other animal I ever saw
-before."
-
-Not long after breakfast Hugh and Jack started out to make a round
-of the camp, and to call upon their friends. As they were passing a
-nice new lodge, a tall, slender, straight young man came out from
-it, and after hesitating a moment as he looked at them, walked up
-to Hugh, and extending his hand, said, "How d'ye do, Mr. Johnson. I
-guess you don't know me, but I've heard of you pretty near all my
-life. I'm Billy Jackson, a son of old Thomas Jackson, whom you may
-have known a long way back, and the nephew of John Monroe."
-
-"Why yes, sure," said Hugh, "I've heard of you, and I used to know
-your mother right well. I'm glad to see you. Ain't you the young
-man that was with General Custer in the Black Hills, and afterwards
-scouted for Miles, down on the Yellowstone? or was it your brother?
-I think you're the man."
-
-"Yes, I'm the man" said Jackson. "Bob scouted for Miles, too, and
-we both did a good deal of riding down there during the last of the
-wars, and now I've come up here to live in the Piegan camp."
-
-"I'm glad to see you," said Hugh. "Let me make you acquainted with
-Jack Danvers; he and I've traveled together now for two or three
-years, and we spent last summer here in Piegan camp."
-
-Jack and Billy Jackson shook hands together, and they parted; but
-Hugh asked Jackson to come round and eat with them that night,
-which the young man said he would do. He was a handsome fellow,
-lean and active; and after they had left him Hugh said to Jack,
-"Take notice of that young man, and if you've occasion to go on the
-prairie with him, do as he says. I've heard of him; he's a good
-man, brave, and knows the prairie well, and, at the same time, he
-has good sense, and isn't likely to get himself or his friends into
-any trouble."
-
-At Little Plume's lodge they were made very welcome. His wife
-had apparently thought that they would come around that day, and
-as soon as they sat down in the lodge, food was set before them:
-boiled buffalo heart and back fat, and berry pemmican, with stewed
-service-berries, made a tempting feast, and Jack ate heartily of it.
-
-Little Plume told them that the next day the camp would move south,
-and they hoped that before they got to the Musselshell, or if not,
-soon after crossing it, they would find buffalo. Hereabouts near
-the Missouri, there were but few, chiefly bulls. Further south,
-between the Musselshell and the Yellowstone, scouts had reported
-great numbers of buffalo. That evening, Last Bull, Iron Shirt,
-and Fox Eye, Jackson and Little Plume, all came to the lodge, and
-they had a feast; and after all had eaten, there was much general
-conversation, but no formal speeches. Much of the conversation was
-in the Piegan tongue, which Jack as yet could hardly understand,
-but Jackson talked much to him in English, and told some
-entertaining stories. Among them was one of an adventure that he
-had had a year or two before, only a short distance from where they
-were now, and which had in it something of humor, and a little of
-danger. Jackson said:
-
-"In the fall of 1879, Paul Sandusky, Jo Hamilton and I built our
-winter quarters on Flat Willow Creek, about twenty miles east of
-the Snowy Mountains. The country was then still infested with
-roving war parties from the different tribes, some coming from
-Sitting Bull's camp on the Big Bend of Milk River.
-
-"As we intended to do some trading with the friendly tribes,
-especially the Crows and Blackfeet, we built commodious quarters,
-consisting of two buildings facing each other and about forty feet
-apart, and containing altogether five rooms. Joining on to the
-'Fort'--as we called it--we constructed a high stockade corral for
-the horses.
-
-"Game of all kinds was very plenty, and bands of elk and antelope
-could be seen almost daily within a mile or so of our place. Glad
-to have company, we gave free quarters to all hunters and trappers
-who cared to stop with us, and by March 1 we numbered eleven men,
-including our cook, 'Nigger Andy.'
-
-"A few hundred yards below our fort a little creek, which we named
-Beaver Castor, joined the Flat Willow. For some miles above its
-mouth it flowed through a deep cut in the prairie, bordered with
-sage brush and willows. At its junction with the Flat Willow, in
-the V formed by the two creeks, was quite a high butte. It sloped
-up very gently from the Flat Willow side, but was almost a cut bank
-on the Beaver Castor side.
-
-"This butte was our watch tower. From its summit we could see miles
-and miles of the surrounding country.
-
-"One morning in March most of the men went out antelope hunting,
-leaving four of us in camp--Jo Healy, laid up with rheumatism;
-Harry Morgan, the herder; the cook and myself. About ten o'clock
-this morning I concluded to take a hunt, and before catching up a
-horse I climbed the butte to see if I could spy a band of elk or
-antelope near by. As soon as I reached the summit I saw some moving
-forms on the prairie not far off, near Beaver Castor, and adjusting
-my glass, I found that they were a large war party of Indians
-afoot. They also saw me, for I saw several of them stop and level
-their telescope at me. I took pains to let them know I was not an
-Indian, for I strutted about with long strides and faced them with
-arms akimbo. Finally, as they came close, I backed down from the
-summit, very slowly, and placing a buffalo chip on top of a bush,
-so as to make them think I was still watching them, I dashed for
-the fort.
-
-"I found that the horse-herder had caught up an animal and gone
-out hunting; so grabbing a lariat I ran out to drive in the band,
-which was grazing nearly a mile from the house. I went down as
-fast as I could run, but found that I couldn't get within roping
-distance of a single animal. They had been in the corral all night
-as usual, and in spite of my efforts they kept straggling and
-feeding along, and every minute I expected the war party to swoop
-down on me. However, I finally got them home and into the corral,
-and, my clothing wet with perspiration, I sat down to get my wind.
-
-"In the meantime Andy had not been idle. He had placed all our
-spare arms and ammunition by the loopholes, had dragged Healy,
-bed and all, to a place of vantage, where he could shoot without
-hurting his rheumatic legs, and had then gone on preparing our
-dinner. So we waited and watched, expecting every minute to be
-attacked. But no Indians came. We had our dinner, and as the
-afternoon passed the boys kept straggling in by ones and twos,
-until by five all were home. None of them had seen any Indians.
-
-"Finally I proposed that two or three of us get our horses and make
-a reconnoissance.
-
-"'We don't want no horses,' said Sagebrush Charlie, 'just you and
-me go up on the butte and take a look from there.'
-
-"I didn't like the proposition, for I surmised that the war party
-were concealed in the brush on Beaver Castor, probably near the
-butte. But on the other hand I didn't care to be bluffed, so I went
-with him.
-
-"As we neared the top of the butte we proceeded very cautiously,
-moving only a step at a time. Only a few yards more and we would
-have reached the summit, when we saw that an Indian on the
-opposite side of the butte was looking at us. We could see nothing
-of him but his head, and of course he could see only our heads.
-Thus we stood facing each other for what to me seemed a long
-time. 'Shall we shoot?' asked Sagebrush. 'No,' I replied. 'If we
-advance to shoot he will have the best of it, and if he advances
-we will have the edge on him.' So we continued to stare at him.
-After a while I saw that the Indian was beginning to back down
-out of sight, so I did the same. I made only a step and he had
-disappeared, but I kept backing away, watching the top of the
-butte, with rifle cocked ready to shoot in an instant. When half
-way down I turned to run and saw Sagebrush just disappearing around
-the corner of the fort. Until then I had supposed that he was at
-my side. So calling him some names I fairly flew down the hill,
-expecting every minute to have a shower of bullets about my ears.
-But I too reached the fort without any sign from the enemy.
-
-"When I got inside I found the boys joking Sagebrush about leaving
-me, and seeing that he was ashamed of himself I said nothing to
-him, although I was quite angry.
-
-"As soon as it was dark we put on a double guard, and kept
-ourselves in readiness for an attack. Late in the evening we
-concluded that the Indians would make a daylight raid on us, so we
-arranged about guard duty and slept by turns. However, we heard
-nothing of our dusky friends, and at six o'clock the cook called
-breakfast as usual. The horses had now been in the corral nearly
-twenty-four hours and were very hungry, so four of us saddled up
-and went out to make a big circle and find out if our friends had
-left us. We went down Flat Willow a mile or more, then swung up
-onto the prairie, crossed Beaver Castor and headed home, but could
-see no Indian signs. Finally we went up on top of the butte, where
-Sagebrush and I had seen the Indian the night before. There in the
-loose shale we found his tracks, and saw that after backing down
-a little ways he had, like us, turned and run by mighty leaps to
-the bottom. There we found a great number of tracks and a lot of
-moccasins, some meat, etc., and following the trail we found that
-the Indians had crossed Beaver Castor and gone up on the prairie,
-where in the thick dry grass we lost all traces of them, and
-concluding that they had left we went home and turned the horses
-out to feed, with a herder and one other man to herd them.
-
-"After dinner, perhaps two or three o'clock, we saw a person on
-foot come down to the creek from the prairie, about half a mile
-below the house. I went down to see who it was, and found to my
-surprise that it was a lone Indian woman, and as soon as I came
-up to her she began to talk to me in a language which I at once
-knew to be Nez Percés, but which I could not understand. I replied
-to her in Sioux, and found that she understood and could speak a
-little of that tongue, and by piecing it out with signs we got
-along very well. I told her to go up to the fort with me and get
-something to eat, and afterward she could tell us her story. When
-we reached the place the boys all crowded around and stared at her,
-and asked all sorts of questions, but I told them to wait, and we
-would hear what she had to say.
-
-"The woman didn't seem to be at all embarrassed. She sat at the
-table and calmly and slowly ate the food the cook set before her,
-not heeding the ten or eleven pairs of eyes that were intently
-watching her. After she had finished eating I asked her to tell us
-where she had come from, where she was going and all about herself,
-and I interpreted her tale, sentence by sentence, to the boys. She
-said: 'I came from Sitting Bull's camp on Milk River, where some
-of my people, Nez Percés, are living with the Sioux. Two years
-ago, my son went with some Sioux and Nez Percés to war against the
-Crows. They had a big fight on the Yellowstone, and it was supposed
-that my son was killed. But not long ago I heard that the Crows
-had captured my boy, and that he is still living and in the Crow
-camp. Having no relatives and no husband, I made up my mind to go
-and live with my son, and started out; this is the twenty-third day
-since I left Milk River. I have been starved most of the time and
-am very tired.'
-
-"'Hush!' said one of the boys, 'That's too durned thin. I move that
-we hang her right now.'
-
-"At this, every one began to talk at once. Some said she was a spy,
-others that she was all right.
-
-"Finally I said to her, 'The boys, some of them, think you are not
-telling the truth. Yesterday a big war party was here, and they
-think you belong to that outfit.'
-
-"'How they lie,' she interposed. 'I haven't seen an Indian since I
-left Milk River.'
-
-"'That may be,' I replied, 'you cannot blame the boys for being
-a little suspicious. However, they will not harm you. You are as
-safe here as you would be among your own people. Just as soon as
-this snow goes, one of our men will start for the Yellowstone with
-a four-horse team after some provisions, and you can go with him.
-From there it is only a short distance to the Crow camp. In the
-meantime you can stay with us here and rest up. Throw off your robe
-and make yourself at home.'
-
-"'I like what you say,' she replied, 'but I am afraid of all these
-men. Let me stay close by you.'
-
-"Wherever I went that afternoon she followed me, and when it came
-time to turn in I made her a bed of buffalo robes behind the
-counter. Some of the boys spread down in the room and others in the
-cook house.
-
-"'I don't like this,' the woman said to me. 'I am afraid to sleep
-there; let me make my bed down beside yours.'
-
-"'Don't fear,' I replied, 'no harm will come to you. No one in this
-place cares for you or wishes to harm you.'
-
-"'Well, then,' she said, 'if that is so I will step out a minute
-and then go to bed.'
-
-"Now the door to this room was fastened from the inside, when we
-wished it, by two wooden bars; outside we closed it merely by a
-rawhide thong and pin. Some of us were always at home, and when
-we all left this room we fastened the door with the thong to keep
-the dogs and the cold air out. As the woman started to go out I
-went up to the counter and took my six-shooter, intending to
-follow her out, but quicker than a flash she darted through the
-door, and closed and fastened it with the thong and pin. Of course
-all the boys in the room made a rush, and two of us getting our
-fingers between the door and the jamb gave a strong jerk, snapped
-the fastening and we all ran out. The woman had disappeared in the
-darkness, but we could still hear her footsteps as she ran toward
-the brush. Suddenly she gave a peculiar kind of a whistle and from
-all around in the brush she was answered by the hooting of owls. We
-all rushed back into the fort, put out the lights and made ready
-for an attack.
-
-"After an hour or so the boys began to talk. 'I knowed,' said one,
-'that she was a spy.'
-
-"'Didn't I say to hang her,' exclaimed another. 'You fellers that
-thought she was all right are sure soft.'
-
-"We all sat up until long after daylight, and not until eight or
-nine o'clock did any one turn in. But we were not attacked, nor did
-we see the woman again.
-
-"Several weeks afterward, when Hamilton went to the Yellowstone
-after supplies, he learned that this woman had stopped at the
-'Circle N' ranch and that they had lost one hundred and forty
-horses."
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER V
-
-BUFFALO HUNTING WITH THE BLACKFEET
-
-
-Early next morning the camp was in motion, and they travelled south
-all day, making a long march. Hugh left the pack horses in charge
-of Fox Eye's people, who drove them along with their own, while
-he and Jack and Joe joined the flankers, who marched off to one
-side, and who killed a few antelope, a few bulls, and hunted out
-the stream bottoms that they passed. Each day these hunters killed
-just about fresh meat enough to support the camp, which as yet had
-plenty of dried meat, so that there was no suffering. That night
-Hugh told Jack that the next day they would strike the Musselshell,
-and very likely buffalo, but if not, they would cross the river and
-move on down toward the Yellowstone, where, on the Dry Fork, or
-Porcupine, they would be sure to get what they wanted.
-
-"We can't stop very long with these people, son," he said; "not
-if we're going into the mountains, and going to work our way down
-through them back to the ranch. Of course we've got lots of time,
-but then we don't want to stay up here too long, and be rushed at
-the last, so that we'll have to hurry along and make our horses
-poor, and keep ourselves tired all the time. We can stop here for
-a while and kill buffalo, and then we'll leave the people, and
-strike west into the mountains."
-
-The next night they camped on the Musselshell, and word was brought
-that about twenty or twenty-five miles to the south buffalo were
-plenty. Orders were given that from now on no one should kill
-buffalo, and camp was moved a day's march still further south,
-to the neighborhood of the herd. The next day a bunch of buffalo
-was located in a place suitable for a surround. That night the
-old crier, as usual, rode around through the camp, telling all
-the people to get in their horses, to tie up their running horses
-close, ordering the women to sharpen their knives, and the men to
-whet their arrow-points, because the next day they were going to
-chase buffalo. The following morning, very early, Jack heard him
-shouting through the camp, calling to the people to "Get up! get
-up!" It was still black night; the stars shone brilliantly in the
-sky, the light of the fire showed through the lodge-skins, and
-sparks were rising with the smoke, when Jack went out to saddle up
-Pawnee. Hugh had had offers of buffalo runners from several of his
-friends. Last Bull had asked him to ride the spotted horse that he
-had several times used the year before, while Jackson had pressed
-upon him a beautiful buckskin that he declared was the best buffalo
-horse in the camp. The excitement which always precedes a buffalo
-chase pervaded the camp, and every one seemed to be hurrying in the
-performance of whatever task was at hand. It was still long before
-daylight when Jack and Hugh, following the men who were starting
-out, found at a little distance from the camp the group of hunters
-who were being held there by the soldiers.
-
-The sky was just becoming gray in the east when the soldiers
-started off, and the hunters followed; and just after the sun had
-risen, the halt was made behind a hill which hid the herd from
-them. After a little pause, and a few low-voiced directions, horses
-were changed, the line spread out, and at first going slowly, rode
-up to the crest of the hill, pushed over it, and hurried down
-toward the unfrightened buffalo. These were slow to see their
-enemies, and the horsemen were close to them before the herd got
-started. Jack held back Pawnee until the word came for the charge,
-and even after that he still restrained him, not wishing him to run
-too hard at first, for the horse was fat, and might lose his wind
-if pushed at the start.
-
-He gave no thought to the whereabouts of his friends; Joe and Hugh
-would no doubt take care of themselves. Just before he overtook
-the last of the bulls, however, he was aware of a man riding close
-to him, and turning saw Billy Jackson, riding the little buckskin,
-without a saddle, and carrying in his hands a bow and some arrows,
-while he had a quiver on his back.
-
-Jack laughed at him, and signed to him that he was armed with good
-weapons, and Jackson nodded. A moment later they were mixed up
-with the dust of the flying herd, and surrounded by buffalo, and
-Jack bent his energies to killing a couple of cows. The bulls were
-soon passed, and Pawnee, running free and easily, forged up to
-the cows. Two fat ones were running just ahead of him, lumbering
-heavily, and with their tongues out, yet getting over the ground
-with surprising speed. He drew up alongside of one, and shot it,
-and it turned a somersault; then touching Pawnee with his heel, he
-was soon riding close to another, which also he killed by a single
-shot. Then turning, he rode back to the last cow, and looked at
-her. She was quite dead.
-
-The task of butchering seemed rather a heavy one, but he went to
-the cow first shot, and, with some trouble split her down the
-belly, and then re-mounting, went back to the other cow, which he
-treated in the same way. Then he sat down on the ground in the
-shade of his horse, and waited.
-
-An hour later the women and girls and children were seen coming
-over the hills with their travois, and scattering out to look at
-the dead buffalo, over many of which men who had returned were now
-working. When Fox Eye's family came along, Jack spoke to the wife,
-and made her understand that these two were his buffalo, and with
-two of the other women she set about skinning and cutting them up.
-
-That night in the lodge, as they were getting ready for bed, Hugh
-said to Jack, "Son, have you ever been through this country before?
-Do you see anything that you recognize?"
-
-"Why yes, Hugh, of course, we came through it last year when we
-were coming north, but I haven't seen anything to-day that I knew."
-
-"Well," said Hugh, "I'm not very much surprised at that, but right
-along here somewhere is where we passed last year, the second or
-third day after we crossed the Yellowstone River, coming north.
-Now, I ain't never forgot that sheep's head that we left up in the
-tree down there. As I told you then, it's a better head than most,
-and likely a better one than you'll ever kill again, and I was
-thinking that it wouldn't be a bad idea for you and me to ride down
-there and get it. We can go in a day, and come back in another, and
-we can easily enough carry the head with us, and take it back to
-the ranch. What do you say?"
-
-"Why, sure Hugh;" said Jack, "I'd like to do that mighty well. I've
-always felt sorry that we lost that sheep head, and felt that I
-wanted it to take back east. I never thought of our getting it this
-year; in fact I never expected to see it again. I'd like very much
-to get it, if you feel like it."
-
-"Well, say we do it. We can start to-morrow or next day; the
-Indians'll be here now two or three days at least, killing and
-drying meat, and we can easily enough go there, and come back and
-catch them before they leave these parts. You and I can go alone,
-or we can take Joe; or if you like, we can ask anybody else that we
-want to go down there with us. It'll be a nice little trip."
-
-So it was arranged that within a day or two they should start for
-the Yellowstone River, to get the sheep's head.
-
-It was the second day after that they finally got away. Joe wanted
-to go with them, and when they told Jackson what they intended
-doing, he said that he too would like to go. This made a party
-of four capable men, to whom no danger could come. They took a
-couple of pack horses, to carry their bedding and provisions, but
-no shelter, for the weather was bright and dry, and there seemed
-no prospect of rain. On their way to the Yellowstone they rode
-constantly through buffalo and antelope, tame and unsuspicious, and
-just moving aside from the track of the travellers as they passed
-along. That night they camped on the little stream just where Jack
-had killed the sheep, and reaching camp before sundown, Hugh and
-Jack rode up the stream to the tree where the sheep's head had been
-placed, took it down and brought it to camp. The ashes of the fire
-of the year before, and the bones of the sheep from which they had
-cut the meat called up old memories. Even the places where the
-lines had been tied for drying the meat were remembered.
-
-Jack was glad enough to get this head again. As Hugh had said, it
-was a very fine one. The great horns swung around in more than a
-complete curve, and although near the base they were more or less
-bruised and battered by the battles the old ram had fought, the
-tips of the horns were very nearly perfect. The skin of the head
-and neck had been picked by the birds and bleached by the weather,
-and Hugh said; "I'm not sure that it will do to use in covering
-the skull, son; but even if it is too hard and sunburned to make
-anything out of, I'd take it along. If we get another good ram on
-the trip you can take his scalp; but if we don't, maybe the man
-that puts up your head can make something out of this."
-
-The next morning before starting back, they rode down to the
-Yellowstone River, and looked up and down the valley. There were
-some buffalo here too, and a few elk; but there was nothing to
-keep them, and they turned about and returned to the Piegan camp,
-which they reached that night.
-
-For some days longer the camp remained here, killing buffalo and
-drying the meat. Then they moved east, one day's journey, to
-another little stream, and again hunted from here. By this time
-many buffalo had been killed, and many robes made. The parfleches
-were full of dried meat and back fat; and now presently the chiefs
-began to consult as to whether they should not go north again to
-the neighborhood of the mountains, for the women wished to gather
-roots and berries for the winter.
-
-One evening when Jack came in from the hunt he saw a great crowd
-of people, men, women and children, gathered just outside of
-the circle. They seemed to be having a good time, for shouts of
-laughter and shrill screams from the women told that something was
-happening which amused them all.
-
-Riding up to the edge of the crowd, Jack saw in the midst of it a
-little buffalo calf, standing there with its head down and tail in
-the air, facing with very determined attitude two or three small
-boys who were trying to approach and get hold of it. Every now and
-then one of the little fellows would get up his courage and venture
-close to the calf's head, when the calf would charge him and the
-boy would jump out of the way; but just as Jack came to a place
-where he could see, one of the boys went slowly forward toward
-the calf, and just as the calf began to charge, one of the boy's
-companions gave him a push forward, so that instead of dodging the
-calf he met its charge, and was knocked sprawling on the ground.
-Then everybody screamed with laughter, and the boy scrambled out of
-the way as fast as he could.
-
-At one side of the ring of people, Jackson was standing, evidently
-much amused at what was going on. Jack called out to him, "What are
-they doing, Billy?"
-
-"Why, I roped this calf to-day and brought him in to try to take
-him back to the river, where there are some cows, and raise him,
-but some of these small boys got bothering and teasing him, and
-I told them if they didn't let him alone I'd turn him loose, and
-let him take care of himself, and now it seems to me he's doing it
-pretty well; he's knocked a half dozen of 'em out of time already,
-and once in a while, if he gets real mad, he charges into the
-crowd, and I tell you they scatter."
-
-The fun went on for a little while longer, and then Jackson, after
-speaking to the people, put a rope about the calf's neck, and with
-the assistance of two young men, dragged it away to his lodge,
-where it was picketed to a stake firmly driven into the ground.
-
-That night, Joe said to Jack, "Say, Jack, do you want to see some
-fun to-morrow?"
-
-"Of course I do," said Jack. "I always want to be around when
-there's any fun going on."
-
-"Well," said Joe, "there's going to be some fun to-morrow; at least
-I think there is. Some of the young men have been making fun of
-Eagle Ribs; they say that there's something he dare not do; to
-jump from his horse to the back of a bull, and ride it. When they
-said that, Eagle Ribs said, 'Why do you talk about doing that?
-You should talk about something that is really dangerous. I should
-not be afraid to jump on a bull's back and ride him; but it's too
-easy; I do not care to do little things like that. It would be a
-trouble to me, and could not do any one any good.' The others kept
-teasing him, and making fun of him, and at last, after they had
-bothered him a good deal, Eagle Ribs said, 'It will be a little
-trouble to do this, but if you want to see me I will do it. I will
-ride a bull; the fastest and strongest that I can choose. Watch me
-to-morrow, and see whether I do it or not.' So to-morrow we're all
-going together, to see whether Eagle Ribs will ride the bull."
-
-"But isn't there danger that the bull will throw him off, and catch
-him and kill him?"
-
-"No," said Joe, "I guess he can stick to it; or, if he can't do
-that, why he'll have to be quick on his feet if the bull does throw
-him; they can't turn very quickly, you know, and Eagle Ribs, if
-he's smart, can get around and keep out of the way of his horns.
-Besides that, there'll be a lot of us there, and we can tease the
-bull, and get him to chase us, if Eagle Ribs should be in any
-danger."
-
-"Well," said Jack, "it's going to be a regular circus, I guess, and
-I'll have to be there."
-
-"Yes," said Joe, "you want to be there if you can; and a lot of us
-young fellows are going to keep pretty close together, and I think
-we'll have a real good time, even if we don't kill any buffalo. The
-camp has got about all the meat now it wants, anyhow."
-
-The next morning before the chase began, Jack and Joe found
-themselves among a lot of boys about their own age, many of whom
-were making fun of and teasing Eagle Ribs. When the chase started
-the boys did not ride as usual to try to catch cows, but instead of
-that singled out some old bulls that made up the rear of the herd,
-and turned them off on to the prairie.
-
-Then they all began to whoop and yell, and call out Eagle Ribs'
-name, and say to him, "Now is the time to show us what you can do.
-Here is your horse; now ride him." Eagle Ribs was riding a good
-horse, and at once accepted the challenge. He pressed the animal
-close up to a bull, and when he was so near that his horse's side
-almost touched the buffalo's side, he reached far forward, grasped
-the long hair on the buffalo's hump, and threw himself from his
-horse onto the bull's back. The bull was frightened, and for a few
-minutes it ran faster than all the horses; and then forgetting that
-it was being chased, and only anxious to get rid of the terrible
-burden that it was carrying, it stopped, and began to plunge and
-buck, and skip around, and acted as if it were a calf instead of a
-huge old bull. Eagle Ribs clung to it with both hands, and with his
-legs, but the bull jumped so high, and came down so hard, that two
-or three times he was shaken from his seat. The boys all about him
-were shouting with laughter, some of them calling out encouraging
-words to the bull, and some to the rider.
-
- [Illustration: "HE REACHED FAR FORWARD, AND GRASPED THE LONG HAIR
- ON THE BUFFALO'S HUMP."--_Page 82._]
-
-The bull seemed very strong, and for a long time did not get tired,
-and two or three times Jack feared that the boy would be thrown
-from his back. Presently, however, the bull stopped, and stood
-with his head down, glaring at the horsemen about him, as if he
-wanted to fight. Now the boys began to ask Eagle Ribs why he had
-stopped; why he did not ride further; and one of them threw his
-quirt to him, telling him that he should use this to make his horse
-go better. Others ran their horses close by, in front of the bull,
-trying to make him charge. Toward one of these horses he rushed
-furiously, and as he did so, Eagle Ribs slipped from his back and
-ran away in the opposite direction, and got behind a horse ridden
-by one of the boys. Jack rode up to him, and signed to him to get
-on behind him, and then they went back to where Eagle Ribs' horse
-was feeding, and he mounted him. Meantime, the bull had run on, and
-some of the boys had killed him.
-
-The next evening the old crier rode about the camp, shouting out
-the orders of the chiefs; telling the people that the next day,
-early, the camp would move back to the great river.
-
-On the evening of that day Jack was awakened by a shot in the camp,
-and then another, and then a rush of people, followed by a swift
-pounding of horses' hoofs on the prairie. He scrambled from his
-bed, put on his moccasins, and seizing his gun and cartridge belt,
-rushed out-of-doors. Joe was standing in front of the lodge, having
-just come out, and Jack asked him what was the matter. "I don't
-know sure," said Joe, "only horses have been stolen."
-
-"Well," said Jack, "why don't they go after the thieves?"
-
-"Oh," said Joe, "that would not do; that is too dangerous. Suppose
-we were to run out onto the prairie, chasing the thieves, they
-could stop behind any sage brush, or the edge of any hill, and
-shoot us as we came up to them, before we could see them. We'll
-have to wait until to-morrow, until it gets light, and then take
-good horses and try to catch them."
-
-The whole camp was now thoroughly awake, and the fires were made
-up in every lodge, while people went about visiting each other,
-and trying to find out what the extent of the loss had been. It
-appeared that only three good horses had been taken; but more would
-have been stolen if it had not happened that a man coming back
-late from a gambling game, and seeing somebody cutting the rope of
-a horse in front of his lodge, had shot at him with a pistol that
-he carried. The enemy threw himself on the horse and rode swiftly
-away, and at the sound of the shot a half dozen men rushed from
-their lodges and fired at the retreating sound.
-
-It was several hours before the camp quieted down again, and before
-daylight next morning forty or fifty men on good horses were
-prepared to follow the trail, and try to overtake the thieves.
-Both Jack and Joe wished to accompany the pursuing party, but Hugh
-advised them not to. He said, "If we had come up here to spend the
-summer with these people, maybe there'd be no harm in your going
-off, but now in the course of a few days we're going to leave them
-and go into the mountains, and if you run your horses down, or if
-either of you should get hurt, why it might spoil our whole trip
-back to the ranch. These Indians ain't likely to overtake those
-fellows, and 'twill just be a long hard ride for nothing. We'd
-better stop at the camp for two or three days more, and then strike
-out for the mountains, just as we intended to, and go on down
-there and see that place they used to call Colter's Hell, and then
-go on down through it, and back to the ranch." The boys, rather
-unwillingly, agreed to do this.
-
-Three days later the Piegan village was once more camped not far
-from the Judith Mountains, and all the pursuing warriors had
-returned, not having overtaken their enemies. Dire were the threats
-that they made against the Crows who had stolen the horses, and a
-number of war parties were made up to go south and make reprisals
-on that tribe.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER VI
-
-AMID WONDERS OF THE YELLOWSTONE PARK
-
-
-It was toward the middle of August that Hugh and Jack and Joe, with
-their little pack train, started southwest, to strike the Carroll
-Road, to go to the place once known as Colter's Hell, and now as
-the Yellowstone Park. Their animals carried only their provisions,
-messkit and bedding, and a skin lodge which Hugh had purchased
-from Fox Eye's wife. Their way led them through the beautiful
-Gallatin Valley, crossing the surveyed line of the Northern Pacific
-railroad, then being built westward, and then over the mountains
-to the valley of the Yellowstone, which they followed up to the
-cañon. Before they reached the Gallatin Valley they had seen plenty
-of buffalo, and had killed one for fresh meat, while in the Valley
-there were many antelope. In the Bridger Mountains, by which they
-passed, elk and deer were abundant; and one morning in the trail
-which they followed were seen the tracks of an enormous bear and
-two small cubs.
-
-In the mountain streams which they crossed, trout were abundant,
-and they greatly enjoyed the delicious fish which were so easily
-caught.
-
-A wagon road had been built through the cañon into the Yellowstone
-Park, and here a number of white people were travelling back and
-forth, and wagons were hauling material for hotels and other
-buildings that were to be put up near the Mammoth Hot Springs. They
-reached these one night, and spent the next day wandering about
-them, marveling at the floods of hot water which poured over the
-many tiny falls, and deposited the lime which had built up the
-terraces of what the people there called "the formations." From an
-old German, Jack purchased three or four articles: a horse shoe, a
-nail, and the twig of a tree which had been suspended in the water
-until coated with a beautiful white covering of lime.
-
-The next day they climbed the hill to the right and came into
-a level park-like country, which they followed south. It was a
-picturesque region, with grand mountains showing on every hand, yet
-nearby, a green level meadow, spangled with wild flowers, and a
-little further back dotted with clumps of pines and spruces, which
-were very beautiful.
-
-At every step there was something new to be seen: new birds,
-new animals, and new scenery. The trail led up a fork of the
-Gardiner River, and then, crossing over, struck one of the heads
-of the Gibbon River, down which they passed, and then suddenly
-found themselves in a country of hot springs, which steamed, and
-sometimes threw up boiling water to a considerable height. This was
-the recently discovered Norris Geyser Basin, and here they camped,
-and spent the day walking about among the hot springs, which at
-first were very awe-inspiring. In many of them there were old tree
-trunks and branches of trees, which, when taken out and examined,
-seemed to be partly turned to stone. Fine particles of a flinty
-material seemed to have penetrated all the pores of the wood, and
-while the branches were not hard, the woody matter in them seemed
-gradually to be changing to stone. As they sat eating their supper
-that night, Hugh said to Jack, "Well, son, I don't wonder that the
-mountain men in old times used to call this Colter's Hell. It is
-surely a place where the flames down below seem to be mighty close
-to the surface of the earth."
-
-"It makes me afraid," said Joe.
-
-"Well," said Jack, "it does me too a little. This morning I was
-afraid pretty nearly every minute that I'd fall through the ground
-and get into hot water below."
-
-The next morning they moved camp, and rode over toward the river
-intending to look at the Grand cañon, and the wonderful falls of
-which they had heard.
-
-Although the Yellowstone Park had been known for more than ten
-years, few people had as yet visited it. Nevertheless, they saw
-a number of visitors, some travelling with teams, and some with
-pack trains, and altogether the Park seemed quite a bustling
-place. That night they camped on the head of Alum Creek, and the
-next day, leaving their pack horses picketed and hobbled at the
-camp, rode over to see the falls. They rode first down toward the
-river, passing the Sulphur Mountain, a great barren hill, full of
-hot springs and sulphur vents, about which much sulphur had been
-deposited. Many fragments of the bright yellow mineral were strewn
-on the ground, and at one place Hugh noticed where two or three
-grass blades had fallen across one of the vents' and calling the
-boys' attention to this, they all dismounted to look at it. About
-these blades of grass, and on their slender heads, most delicate
-and beautiful crystals of sulphur had collected. These were so
-fragile that a little motion made them loose their hold, and drop
-from the grass, or else break, so that it was impossible to carry
-them away. Near here, at the foot of the hill, was a large spring,
-six or eight feet in diameter, and boiling violently. The water
-was sometimes thrown up eight or ten feet high, not in jets, but
-seemingly by impulses from the center of the pool, so that the
-spray was sent outward in all directions.
-
-They then followed down the river for two or three miles. It was a
-broad stream, swiftly-rushing yet smooth, and nowhere interrupted
-by rocks or rapids until the upper falls were almost reached. Here
-were short rough rapids and then the tremendous falls. The great
-mass of dark water glided rather than plunged into the depths
-below, and just below the crest of the cataract was broken into
-white foam, which, further down changed to spray. The falls are
-162 feet high, and clouds of white vapor constantly rose from the
-water below, and hid the view. Looking down the stream, they had a
-glimpse of the wonderful cañon below.
-
-The roar of the falls was so tremendous that conversation was
-impossible, and nothing was said; but presently they left the upper
-falls and rode on north to the lower one. Here was repeated the
-marvelous impression which they got from this tremendous body of
-water falling 150 feet sheer to the great basin below, and from
-under the mist cloud that hid the foot of the fall came out the
-narrow green ribbon of the river, winding and twisting, hardly to
-be recognized as a river, dwarfed by distance, and creeping with a
-slow oily current. On either side the stream rose the walls of the
-cañon, five or six hundred feet to the pine-fringed margin above.
-
-Looking down the stream, Jack saw a cañon a thousand feet deep, and
-perhaps twice as wide, extending for miles to the northward. Its
-sides were curiously sculptured and carved into fantastic forms. In
-one place a vertical cliff supported lofty cones of rock, ranged
-side by side upon the same horizontal ledge along its face. Again,
-a narrow buttress arose from the river's level in a series of
-pinnacles and turrets overtopping one another, until the summit of
-the cañon wall was reached. At one place that wall was so nearly
-perpendicular that it seemed as though a stone dropped from the
-edge of the cliff would fall at once into the water of the river.
-In another, the decomposing rock had been eaten away above until
-a talus of fallen rock and earth arose in a steep slope half way
-to the top. But to Jack's mind the glory of the cañon was in its
-color. The walls glowed with a vivid intense radiance which is
-not less wonderful than beautiful. Browns and reds and pinks and
-yellows, and delicate grays and pure whites had painted these hard
-rocks with a wealth of coloring hardly to be described in words.
-In the sun the cañon walls shone with brilliancy. When the clouds
-passed over the sky they grew duller and softer, but were hardly
-less beautiful. Down close to the river were the most vivid greens,
-and in the mist which rose from the foot of the fall were seen,
-when the sun was shining, all the hues of the rainbow.
-
-The travellers sat long watching this wonderful sight, and then
-pushing along the margin of the cañon, below the falls, walked out
-on a projecting point of rock, and looked up and down the river.
-The more they gazed, the more wonderful it seemed, the harder to
-take it all in, and the harder to put into words.
-
-On a pinnacle of rock, rising from the end of the point on which
-they had walked, was a great nest, in which the boys noticed two
-large and downy young birds. Flying up and down over the river,
-sometimes low over the water, again far above the heads of those
-who stood on the edge of the cañon, were great hawks--eagles,
-Hugh afterward said they were, but Jack recognized them as
-fish-hawks--and while they were standing there, one of these great
-birds brought a fish to the nest, and tearing it to pieces with its
-beak, gave the fragments to its greedy young. Jack noticed, also,
-little sparrow-hawks flying about the edge of the cañon, and, far
-below at the edge of the river, saw little birds flying from point
-to point, which he thought must be dippers.
-
-The whole day was spent here, for no one seemed to wish to return
-to the camp; but at last, as the sun swung low, and the pangs
-of hunger began to be felt, they returned to their horses, and
-mounting them, were soon at camp once more.
-
-The next morning they set out up the river to go to the lake. On
-the way they passed two well known places. The Mud Volcano, a huge
-hot spring of gray clay, which steamed, and bubbled, and thumped,
-and sometimes spouted, throwing up its mud to a great height. Jack
-in his mind compared the boiling mud to mush boiling in a kettle,
-but as this pool of mud was fifty feet in diameter, the comparison
-was not a good one. All about, the trees were splashed with mud,
-which had dried on them, showing that at some time, not long
-before, there had been an eruption. Nearby, on the hillside, was
-a steam spring in a little cavern, which they had heard of as the
-Devil's Workshop. From this cavern came constantly great volumes
-of steam, while within it were heard hollow bubbling noises, which
-sounded like the clang and clash of great pieces of machinery
-turning. It was a mysterious place, and neither one of the three
-cared to go very close to it. There were boiling springs and
-sulphur vents hereabout in great plenty, and the place seemed an
-uncanny one.
-
-The way to the lake was attractive: it led through forests,
-sometimes of living green, and at others killed by fire.
-Occasionally they passed through pretty grassy meadows, and from
-them had charming views of the river, which grew wider as they
-approached the lake, and seemed to spread out over wide flats.
-To the right the mountains rose sharply, forming the "Elephant's
-Back," a thousand feet in height.
-
-Presently they came to a broad opening, and saw before them the
-lake. At the outlet the grass grew thick and rank, and in the
-marshes, pond-holes and sloughs here, they saw many flocks of wild
-ducks and geese; and sand-pipers and beach birds fed along the
-shore. Some swans were seen, and a few great white pelicans.
-
-Their fresh meat was now exhausted, and for a day or two they had
-been living on trout, of which great numbers were caught in the
-streams that they had crossed, for fish are abundant everywhere in
-the mountains. When they made camp that night, Jack got out his
-line, and cutting a pole, went down to the shore to catch some
-fish, while Hugh and Joe made the fire.
-
-Jack had hardly thrown his hook in the water when it was seized,
-and he dragged a large fish to shore. As he was taking it off the
-hook however, he noticed a bunch on its side, and after examining
-it for a moment, cut into this bunch with his knife, and drew from
-it a long white worm. He got a dozen trout, but all of them seemed
-to be afflicted with this parasite, and finally putting up his line
-he carried them to the fire, and showed them to Hugh. Both Hugh and
-Jack agreed that these fish were not fit to eat, and that night
-they supped on dried meat and back-fat.
-
-As they had made camp that night they had noticed, just beyond
-them, two white tents, and had seen some horses feeding near the
-lake shore. Shortly after their supper, a man walked into the camp,
-and after saluting them, sat down by the fire. A little talk showed
-that he was a member of the geological survey that worked in the
-Park, and he had been attracted to their camp by the fact that
-they had an Indian lodge. He was a pleasant man, and seemed quite
-willing to talk, and to answer all their questions, and very much
-interested in his work. After he and Hugh had talked together for
-a while, Jack ventured to ask some questions about the Park, and
-especially about the place where they now were. "Won't you tell me,
-sir," he said, "what you can about this big lake that we are on.
-It looks to me awful big to be up here high in the mountains. Of
-course I know it isn't anything like the Great Lakes; still it's
-the largest lake I ever saw."
-
-"It is a large lake," said their visitor, "for it contains about
-150 square miles of water, and there is probably no lake in North
-America of equal size at so great an elevation. You see, we are
-about 7700 feet above the level of the sea. Roughly speaking, the
-shape of the lake is like that of an open hand which lacks the
-first and middle finger; the wrist is the northern end of the lake,
-the west arm answers to the outstretched thumb, and the south and
-southeast arms to the ring and little finger. If you are going to
-travel around it, you will feel that it is a lovely sheet of water.
-It is very picturesque, and in fair weather it lies here like a
-great sapphire beneath the unclouded sky. But when the storms come
-up, and the wind rolls down along the mountain sides, the lake can
-get up a great sea, and one would not care to be out on it. But in
-fair weather it is very beautiful--to me the loveliest spot in all
-the park. And what is more, I never get tired of it; the more I see
-it, and the more familiar I become with its scenery, the lovelier
-it is. From every promontory and every bay, and from every
-hillside above it, one has always a different view, and each view
-has a charm that is all its own."
-
-The geologist sat there long with them that night, talking to them
-in a most interesting way about the Park and the geysers and the
-cañons. He told them that all this country was volcanic in origin,
-and that for some reason or other, which he did not know, the heat
-still remained close to the surface of the earth; and that this was
-the reason that there were so many hot springs and geysers here.
-
-"It's one of the most interesting regions in the world," he said,
-"and one of the most beautiful. As yet, people do not appreciate
-it. Many people do not even know that it exists; but the time
-will come when thousands will gather here each summer, from all
-quarters of the world, to see its beauties. Geologically, it is
-most interesting, and already geologists from all over the world
-are coming to see it, or are making plans to come. I predict that
-the time is coming when the Yellowstone Park will be acknowledged
-to be the most wonderful place in the world."
-
-As the visitor rose to go, he looked about the lodge and said,
-"So this is an Indian lodge, is it? I've often read about them,
-but this is the first one I've ever seen. They seem warm and
-comfortable, but are they not rather smoky?"
-
-"No," said Hugh, "they're not smoky; but you must remember they're
-not made to stand up in; people in the lodge are expected to sit
-down, or to lie down. If there's a fire burning, and no wind
-blowing, or if the air is damp and heavy, smoke often gathers in
-the top of the lodge, and a man standing in it finds about his
-head more than he likes. Stoop down a little bit and you will see
-that the smoke no longer troubles you." The geologist did as Hugh
-advised, and seemed to be greatly interested by the discovery that
-it was as he had said; and then bidding them good night, he left
-the lodge.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER VII
-
-GEYSERS AND HOT SPRINGS
-
-
-They were afoot before the sun had arisen next morning, and the
-outlook over the lake was beautiful. Away to the east and south
-were many mountain peaks, the names of which they did not know; but
-all grand and majestic, and far away to the south was one larger
-than any of the others, and covered with snow. As Jack looked at
-them, he saw these snowy crowns take on a glow of pink, and then
-grow brighter and brighter, and then could see the sunlight creep
-down the sides of the mountains, and finally it was broad day. The
-islands in the lake interested him, and he thought them beautiful.
-
-As they passed the geologist's camp, they saw him standing with his
-back to the fire, and he called out good morning to them; then,
-signing to Hugh to draw near, he said, "Excuse me for asking you,
-but I suppose you have been to the Upper and Lower Geyser Basins?"
-
-"Well," said Hugh, "we've been to one geyser basin; that one on the
-way to the falls, but that's the only one we've seen."
-
-"Well," said the geologist, "of course you know your own affairs
-best, but it seems to me you will make a great mistake if you do
-not get to the Upper and Lower Geyser Basins, because it's there
-that the most wonderful geysers are to be seen."
-
-"Well," said Hugh, "we're travelling through here to see the
-sights, and I'd be mightily obliged to you if you'd tell me what
-we'd better do. We are strange to the country, and don't know
-anything about it."
-
-"I shall be very glad to help you in any way that I can," said the
-geologist, "and you certainly should not miss the geyser basins.
-You can follow the trail along the lake here for about twenty
-miles, and then turn to your right, at the end of the Thumb, and
-strike northwest across through the timber, to the streams running
-into the Firehole River, and follow them down, and that will take
-you to the Lower Geyser Basin; then from there you must travel
-up the Firehole to the Upper Geyser Basin. Then, if you want to,
-you can cross over to Shoshone and Lewis Lakes, and go on south,
-following Snake River, to Jackson's Lake. From there you can go
-wherever you please, but if you choose to follow up Pacific Creek,
-and pass through Two Ocean Pass, that will bring you back on the
-upper Yellowstone, and then you can come down to the lake again."
-
-"Well," said Hugh, "we want to go south, and to get down on the
-streams that run into the Platte. I reckon we might as well go
-down to Jackson's Lake the way you say, and then strike across the
-country, over into the Wind River drainage, and then over onto the
-Platte."
-
-"Yes, I guess that is one very good way to go if you know the way
-across the range," said their friend.
-
-"Well," said Hugh, as he started on, "we'll try to find a way, and
-anyhow we're mightily obliged to you for telling us about those two
-geyser basins, and we'll sure see them before we go south;" and
-saying goodbye to their acquaintance, they rode on.
-
-A few miles further along the trail, they came to a natural bridge,
-spanning a brook which now carried little water, but showed that
-in the spring it was much larger. The stream had burrowed its way
-beneath a dike of lava, at right angles to its course, and was
-bridged by a nearly perfect arch of rock, about six feet thick
-above the keystone. From the top of the bridge on its lower side
-to the bed of the stream is about sixty feet, and the bridge is
-twenty-five feet long, and the arch fifteen feet in width. The lava
-stands in upright layers, from one to four feet in thickness, and
-seems to have separated into these thin plates in cooling.
-
-Beyond the bridge, the dim trail which they followed led for the
-most part through the pleasant green timber, but at midday they
-passed over several hog-backs, from which the timber had long ago
-been burned off, most of the tree trunks had rotted away, and only
-a few charred fragments of the roots remained on the ground. No
-young growth had sprung up to replace the old, and the ground was
-bare: not merely bare of timber, but bare even of underbrush, weeds
-and grass. Exposed for years to the full force of the weather, the
-rains and melting snows had swept away all the rotted pine needles,
-twigs and fallen branches which had formed the old forest floor and
-soil, leaving only the fine lava sand and gravel, without any soil
-to support vegetation. Dry, thirsty and desolate, these hog-backs
-resembled the desert, a barren waste in the midst of the green pine
-forest.
-
-Hugh turned to Jack and said, "You see, son, what the forest fires
-may do in these mountains. When the timber burns off, unless there
-are seeds in the soil to spring up at once, the snow, melting
-quickly, washes away the soil, and leaves the rock, whether it is
-solid or broken up fine like this here, uncovered and without the
-power to support anything. Every year the snow melting quickly
-washes off a larger tract, and so these little deserts increase in
-size. The time is coming, I am afraid, when these mountains will
-all be burned over, and then what the ranchmen down on the prairie
-are going to do for water for their hay meadows and their crops I
-don't know."
-
-"But, Hugh," said Jack, "aren't there laws forbidding people to set
-the timber on fire?"
-
-"Yes," said Hugh, "there's plenty of laws, but the trouble is
-nobody pays any attention to them."
-
-Toward evening they camped on the shores of the lake, at what Hugh
-supposed was the Thumb, and he told the boys that the next day he
-was going to start off northwest through the timber, and try to
-strike the streams leading down to the Firehole.
-
-Making an early start, they rode up the hill, following a deep
-ravine through the cool green timber, over ground covered with
-feathery moss, where the hoofs of the animals made no sound as they
-struck the ground. Soon the lake was lost to view, and then, on
-all sides of them rose the tall straight boles of the pine trees.
-There seemed not very much life. A few small birds were seen in
-the tops of the trees. Some gray jays gathered near them when they
-stopped at midday to eat, and uttered soft mellow whistles, and two
-came down very close to Jack and Joe, and picked up little bits of
-dried meat that they threw to them.
-
-Soon after they started on, they came to a stream, and following
-that down, about three or four o'clock rode into the Lower Geyser
-Basin.
-
-Here was a large wet meadow, with green grass, and plenty of
-good camping spots; and before long they had the lodge up, and
-closing the door, started out to make a tour of the basin. The
-many geysers, large and small, and the wonderful hot springs of
-surpassing clearness and deep blue color astonished and delighted
-Hugh and the boys. Many of the springs were very hot, seeming to
-boil from beneath, bubbles of steam following one another to the
-surface, and then exploding. One of these large springs, about
-twenty-five feet long and more than half as wide, gave a vigorous
-display, beginning first to boil at the middle, and then to spout;
-at length throwing the water about in all directions, from twenty
-to forty feet in height. The margins of all these geysers and hot
-springs were beautifully ornamented with yellow gray and pinkish
-deposits of stone, which took the form of beads and corals and
-sponges, and all the tree trunks and branches seen in and near them
-were partly turned to stone. Close to the geysers were what are
-called the paint-pots. These are boiling pools of finely divided
-clay of various colors. The air seemed to be forced up slowly
-through the thick fluid, making little puffs, much like those
-that one would see in a kettle of boiling indian meal. Some of
-these paint-pots were very large, others small, and they were of
-a variety of colors--some red, some white, some yellow, and some
-softly gray. The clay was exceedingly smooth to the touch.
-
-The Geyser Basin was long, and contained a great many wonderful
-springs and geysers, of which some, like the Grotto, had built up
-great craters for themselves, twelve or sixteen feet high.
-
-The Grotto was at the end of the Lower Geyser Basin, and from here
-they turned back to go to their camp. Much talk was had during the
-evening of the wonderful things that they had seen, and of what
-they expected to see in the morning.
-
-An early start brought them to the Upper Geyser Basin not long
-after the sun had risen. Not far from the Grotto which they had
-seen last night was the Giant, with an enormous crater, from which
-great volumes of steam were escaping, and where the water could be
-heard boiling below the surface, and occasionally rising in great
-jets which splashed over the top. They camped near at hand, and
-turning out their horses, proceeded on foot to see Old Faithful,
-the Bee-hive, the Giantess, the Grand, and many other large
-geysers, besides many hot springs wonderful in color and in the
-purity of their waters.
-
-Just before they reached Old Faithful, the roar of its discharge
-was heard, and its wonderful shaft of water was seen rising, by
-two or three rapid leaps finally to a height of over one hundred
-feet, with clouds of steam reaching far higher, and drifting off
-with the wind. The great column of water maintained its height for
-fully five minutes, and then, dropping by degrees, it sank down
-and disappeared. All about the crater the naked shell of silica
-which surrounds it was flooded with water, so hot that Jack and
-Joe, who tested it with their fingers, shook them violently and at
-once thrust them into their mouths. The crater of this geyser is
-very beautiful. It stands on a little mound and is four or five
-feet high, and its lips are rounded into many strange and beautiful
-forms, beaded and shining like glistening pearls, while all about
-it are little terraced pools of the clearest water, with scalloped
-and beaded borders. The margins and floors of these pools are
-tinted with most delicate shades, white, buff, brown and gray,
-and in many of them are beautiful little pebbles, which are also
-opalescent.
-
-Many cruel hands had been at work breaking down these beautiful
-borders, to carry them away, and people who had visited the place
-had scrawled their names on the smooth pebbles and in the beautiful
-flooring of the pools.
-
-Hugh said to Jack, "Well, we come from the Indians, and we belong
-in a cow camp; but we ain't low down enough to spoil pretty things
-like these, by writing our names on 'em, are we, son?"
-
-"No, Hugh, we're not," said Jack, "and I'm mighty glad of it. I
-don't think anybody that had any love for pretty things would want
-to spoil them in this way, or take any of this beautiful bordering
-away with them. You get these pretty things away from their
-surroundings, and they are not pretty any longer. It's like picking
-a beautiful flower and carrying it away with you; before you've
-got far, it's all faded and gone, and good for nothing except to
-throw away."
-
-During the day, which seemed to them all too short, the geysers
-were good to them. The Bee-hive played, throwing up a slender shaft
-of water to a height of about 200 feet; the Grand Geyser sent up a
-stream eighty feet in height; the Castle played, but its exhibition
-was not very showy compared with the others that they had seen. But
-toward afternoon, the greatest of all the geysers, the Giantess,
-gave an exhibition of her power, throwing up a vast quantity of
-water, sometimes to a height of one hundred feet. While the geyser
-was playing, Jack and Joe brought a large tree stump and threw it
-into the basin, and it was instantly whirled to a height of 200
-feet, looking at the last like a tiny piece of wood. The wind,
-which was blowing, kept the steam and water from going nearly as
-high as the stump went. The roar of the geyser was tremendous,
-and its force shook the ground all about, so that those who were
-looking on were almost afraid.
-
-As they returned to camp that night they saw a party of tourists
-moving about among the geysers, and passing near they could see
-that they were busy with axes and a pick, cutting away and prying
-out the borders of some of the geyser pools. It was an irritating
-sight, but they could do nothing, and much of the way back to camp
-was devoted to talking of the wickedness of destroying the beauties
-of this place, and declaring that the government ought to do
-something to protect the wonders of the region from the destruction
-which constantly threatened them.
-
-At night, after supper, they sat in the lodge talking about what
-they should do to-morrow, and for the following days. Generally,
-their idea was to travel in a southeasterly direction, and finally
-to bring up at Mr. Sturgis' ranch; but just how they should go was
-uncertain. Neither Jack nor Joe had ever before travelled in the
-mountains, and they were therefore quite dependent on Hugh for
-advice. Jack said, "Of course, Hugh, we want to get back to the
-ranch, but then, too, we want to see as much as we can of what
-there is in the mountains; but I suppose we'll have to travel
-by some trail or some road, because we can't take the horses
-everywhere."
-
-"Well, that's so," said Hugh; "we can't go everywhere, but then
-again, when you are travelling with a pack train there's mighty
-few places where you can't go; you're mighty free and independent
-when you're packing. Of course you can't take a pack train up a cut
-cliff; but, on the other hand, the rough mountains and down timber
-don't cut much figure; you can pretty much always go round, and
-keep your general direction. You can go and come about as you want
-to."
-
-"Well," said Jack, "of course I never travelled before with a pack
-train in the mountains, but I tell you I like it. It's a mighty
-pretty sight to see the white packs winding in and out among the
-timber, or to see them following one another along a narrow ridge,
-or zigzaging up and down a steep hillside, as we've seen them since
-we've been here in the Park."
-
-"Yes," said Hugh, "it's a nice way to travel; of course it's a
-little slower than a wagon, and it takes you some time to load and
-unload; but then again you can often go straight, instead of going
-a long way round, and I like it."
-
-"I tell you," said Joe, "I like to watch these horses. I don't know
-whether they've ever been in the mountains before, but it seems
-to me they're smart. They seem to know a whole lot, and I notice
-that when they're going along among the trees, sometimes I see a
-horse start to go between two trees, where I think there isn't
-room enough for the pack, but generally they get through. Then,
-sometimes, going under branches it seems to me that the pack has
-got to strike the branches, but the horses generally get under them
-without touching. Of course if they follow old Baldy close, there
-is always room enough; but now and then that dun horse tries to
-cut off a corner, and get in ahead of one of the others, and then
-sometimes I think he's bound to get caught. He only did so once,
-day before yesterday, and then he went between two trees where
-there wasn't room enough; then he pushed and pushed and pushed for
-a long time, and I had to run round in front of him and drive him
-back, and then he got out."
-
-"Yes," said Hugh, "horses that are used to the mountains, or mules
-or burros, get to be mighty smart in going through thick timber,
-and if the packs are properly put on, there isn't likely to be much
-trouble, unless you strike down timber. Of course, down timber is
-bad."
-
-"Well, what is down timber, Hugh?" said Jack. "I've heard of places
-in the woods back east where a hurricane goes along and tears up
-all the trees in a strip for miles in length. They call that a
-wind-fall there. Is that the way down timber is made here?"
-
-"No," said Hugh, "we've plenty of wind here, but it don't often
-act that way. Down timber comes like this: say that you have a
-rough and rocky mountain side, where the timber stands thick,
-most of the trees will be from six to ten inches in diameter, but
-they'll all be pretty near of a size. Now, suppose a fire passes
-over this, and kills all these trees; likely it doesn't burn them
-to amount to anything, but it's hot enough to sort o' cook the
-sap, and kill the trees. They'll stand there naked, with the bark
-gradually drying up and peeling off them, maybe for twenty, thirty
-or forty years; and likely while they're standing there, there'll
-be a new growth of young pines springing up among them, and grow to
-quite a height. But after a while these dead trees get white and
-weathered, and the dead roots that hold them in the ground keep on
-rotting and rotting, and at last these roots become so weak that
-there's nothing to support the tall trunk that stands there, and
-then with every big wind that comes blowing along, some of the
-trees get blown over, and fall to the ground. They don't all fall
-at once, but some may fall to-day with a south wind, and some may
-fall next week with a west wind, and some the week after with a
-north wind. In this way they're falling all the time, and in all
-sorts of directions, and presently the timber will lie piled up on
-the ground there, criss-cross in all directions. Now, if the logs
-are not more than a foot or two above the ground, and don't lie
-too close together, you can take your train through them, but if
-they lie three or four feet high, of course the horses can't step
-or jump over them, and you've either got to go winding round among
-them, picking out the low places where the animals can get across,
-or else you've got to chop your way through, or else you've got to
-back out and go round. That's down timber."
-
-"But Hugh," said Jack, "I should think it would be kind of
-dangerous to ride through one of those patches of dead timber when
-the wind is blowing; they might fall on you."
-
-"Well," said Hugh, "so they might. I've sometimes had to ride
-through a patch of that timber when the trees were falling all
-about, but I never happened to have one fall on me, nor on any
-animal that I was driving. The chances are mighty few that you'll
-get hit. I mind one time a big tree fell, with the top about twenty
-feet from one of my animals, and threw dirt and splinters all about
-him. The horse was scared a whole lot, and ran away; but of course
-I got him again."
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER VIII
-
-ACROSS THE CONTINENTAL DIVIDE
-
-
-The next morning they made an early start, and following up the
-Firehole, turned up a branch coming in from the east, only a
-short distance beyond Old Faithful. They purposed to go over to
-Shoshone Lake, and camp there, and to do this they must pass over
-the Continental Divide, for the Firehole finds its way through the
-Madison River, and the Missouri, to the Atlantic Ocean, while the
-waters of the Shoshone Lake fall into Snake River, then into the
-Columbia, and so at last reach the Pacific.
-
-The way was pleasant, through park-like openings and green timber,
-and the distance not great. There was no trail, but they followed
-up a narrow grassy valley, whose slopes on either side were clothed
-with pines.
-
-At last, when Hugh thought they must be near the Divide, they
-found down timber, and began to wind about among the logs. Little
-by little, however, matters grew worse, and presently a stick was
-encountered over which old Baldy could not step, but on which he
-caught his foot and almost fell. Here all hands dismounted, and
-getting an ax out of a pack, Hugh and the boys went ahead, and by
-lifting some of the larger sticks, and breaking smaller ones, and
-a little chopping, a way was soon made by which the horses could
-pass along.
-
-Beyond this timber was an open and almost level country, which Hugh
-declared was the Divide, and passing along a little further, they
-began to go down a gentle hill. Here there were park-like meadows
-and low wooded hills on either side. There were a few little
-gullies, but no water; and in the dry stream-beds and water-holes
-were many tracks of elk, all made in the spring when the ground was
-soft. From the summit of this Divide, when snows are melting in
-the early summer, little trickles of water pour down the opposite
-sides of the mountains, some to the north, to find their way into
-the Firehole; others south toward Snake River. Hugh followed the
-general direction of one of these water-courses, which constantly
-grew larger, and presently turned into one still wider, whose sandy
-bottom was dotted with great blocks of black lava. Hugh pointed out
-these to the boys, and said to them, "That's the stuff that in old
-times many of the Indians used to make their arrow points from. It
-must have been a great article of trade, for away up north of the
-boundary line I have seen little piles of chips of that black glass
-lying on the prairie, where men have been making arrow-heads, and I
-know that there wasn't any of the rock within 400 miles."
-
-All along the valley of this dry stream was a beautiful park of
-gently rolling country, with timbered knolls and open grassy
-intervales. Some of the trees were very large--two or three feet in
-diameter.
-
-It was early in the afternoon when they reached Shoshone Lake,
-and riding along its smooth, firm beach, camped in a little point
-of spruces. The lake was large, and looked as if it should have a
-fish in it. Jack got out his rod and put it together, and standing
-it against a tree, went back into the open meadow where the horses
-were feeding, to catch grasshoppers. He caught half a dozen, and
-then, returning, fished faithfully for quite a long distance along
-the shore, but without success. Neither could he see anywhere that
-fish were rising, and he wondered whether it could be possible that
-this beautiful lake, which seemed an ideal home for trout, should
-have none in it. Joe, on the other hand, as soon as camp had been
-made, had taken his rifle and started out on foot, working along
-the edge of the lake and looking for game. He found many old elk
-tracks and a very few made by deer, but went quite a long distance
-without seeing anything. Then, turning away from the shore of the
-lake, and taking the hillside at some distance from it, he began to
-work back to the camp. Here there were more deer tracks, but none
-that seemed worth while for him to follow, and he began to feel
-discouraged. When he had come almost opposite the camp he crossed
-a wide dry water-course, going now rather carelessly, though still
-making no noise, yet not trying to keep out of sight. As he climbed
-the gentle slope, after crossing the little valley, and had almost
-reached the top, he stopped, and turned about and looked backward,
-and there to his astonishment saw, projecting above a patch of low
-willows and weeds, the heads of two fawns. They were staring at him
-most innocently, but the camp needed meat, and bringing his rifle
-to his shoulder he fired at the neck of one of them, and the little
-deer disappeared, while the other turned about and raced away
-through the brush.
-
-Going to the place Joe found the fawn quite a small one, though it
-had already lost its spotted coat. He dressed it, and then throwing
-it on his shoulders walked quickly to the camp. As he came in front
-of the lodge, Hugh said to him, "Hello, Joe, what have you got
-there, a jack rabbit?"
-
-"Well," said Joe, "it is not much bigger, but it's the only thing
-I have seen except another of the same size, and that I could not
-shoot at."
-
-That night as the sun went down the wind began to blow a fresh dry
-wholesome breeze from the west. The wind raised quite a sea on the
-lake, and big waves tumbled up on the beach one after another,
-so fast that it was not an easy matter to get a bucket of water
-without at the same time getting a wet foot. Jack and Joe walked
-along the beach a little way.
-
-"Do you know, Joe," said Jack, "this looks to me just like the
-seashore; the wind blows in the same way, and the waves have the
-same white-caps, and the surf roars as it pounds on the beach; and
-there is the moon on the water. Why it seems to me just like some
-nights I have walked on the beach, back east on the Long Island
-shore."
-
-"Well," said Joe, "it's not like anything I ever saw before. Up in
-our country we don't have sand beaches like this, though we do have
-the lake, and the waves and the wind."
-
-The animals were packed early next day, and they followed the
-shores of the lake southward. In some places they could see where
-elk had passed along recently, and there were tracks of bulls and
-cows and calves. In some places, too, along the beach the pines,
-which were small yet looked old, were all bent toward the eastward,
-and had no branches on the western side. Joe pointed these trees
-out to Hugh and said, "Why is it Hugh that these trees seem all
-bent one way, and have no branches on the other side; is it the
-wind?"
-
-"Yes," said Hugh, "the wind. You'll see that in lots of places,
-especially on mountain tops, and along big waters like this, where
-the wind blows mostly from the west and northwest, and gets a wide
-sweep."
-
-The wind was still blowing hard, and the lake was in a turmoil. The
-air was cold, and all hands wore their coats as they rode along.
-
-A day's journey took them by Shoshone Lake and Lewis Lake, and
-they camped below it on Lewis Fork. For much of the distance the
-trail passed through an attractive open country, full of streams
-and springs, and dotted with clumps of thick willow brush; while on
-the higher lands were the ever-present pines. To the left was the
-lofty ridge of the Red Mountain Range, down which half a hundred
-beautiful cascades hurried toward the river. To the right was the
-stream, and beyond the steep sides of the Pitchstone Plateau, so
-called from the black glossy fragments of the lava rock, of which
-the soil is largely made up. It was evident that this would be
-a hard trail in the early spring, for it was low and wet, and
-animals would have trouble in passing over it at any except the
-dry season.
-
-A few miles below the camp they began to look for a ford. The
-stream looked deep and difficult, yet it was necessary for them to
-cross it, for on the east side the mountains came down close to the
-river in a steep and impassable jumble of slide rock. Just above
-them they could see a great water-fall, not far below the lake.
-It was now getting toward night, and Hugh was a little uncertain
-whether to cross this stream, or to camp on this side. However, he
-determined to cross, and stopping, had the boys catch up the pack
-animals, while he rode into the stream to prospect for a ford. He
-kept diagonally down the river, going very slowly, and feeling for
-the shoalest places, but at last, reached the opposite bank and
-climbed out. Then, turning about, he recrossed, and telling the
-boys to keep the horses close to him, he led them into the stream.
-The ford was rather deep, the water coming more than half way up
-the horses' bodies, so that they all tucked their feet up behind
-them on the saddle, and rode along with some anxiety, lest a false
-step or a stumble over the great stones which formed the river
-bottom should throw down one of the animals, and so wet either a
-pack or a rider. However, the crossing was made safely, and then
-climbing the steep hill, they kept on through the timber, soon,
-however, camping by a little spring, in an opening where there was
-food for the animals.
-
-By the time camp was made, the sun had set and it was too late to
-hunt. The little deer had all been eaten, and once more they made
-their meal on dried meat and back-fat.
-
-The next day they kept on through the green timber, riding over
-ridges and at a distance from the stream, though now and then they
-had glimpses of its dark hurrying waters. To the right were seen
-some little lakes, one of them covered with water-fowl. Across the
-trail that they were following--if it could be called a trail--was
-some fallen timber, but nothing that delayed them. Jack noticed
-that some of the living trees were curiously bent in their growth,
-sometimes at right angles to the vertical a foot or two from the
-ground, the trunk growing six inches or a foot horizontally, and
-then turning once more straight toward the sky, the remainder
-of the tree being straight as an arrow. In some cases the bend
-was more than this, the tree growing straight up for a foot, and
-then turning over, growing down for a few inches or a foot, and
-then making another curve, and growing upright once more. Some of
-these curves were almost shaped like the letter S, and Jack kept
-wondering what caused these bends. As they stopped at midday to
-unsaddle and let the horses feed and to eat something themselves,
-Jack asked Hugh about the curious way in which these trees grew.
-
-Hugh smiled and said, "I don't much wonder you ask about that, son.
-I remember that I used to think about that a good deal, and wonder
-how it happened. But it is easy enough to explain if you once get
-onto it, and you can easily enough get onto it if you travel around
-through the mountains enough.
-
-"You know I told you the other day," he continued, "that when a
-country has been burned over, the trees stand for a good many
-years, and then they commence to fall in all directions. Likely
-enough before they begin to fall, a whole lot of young trees and
-sprouts have started from the ground, and are growing among them.
-Now, nothing is more likely than that some of these falling trees
-may happen to fall upon these young saplings and sprouts. Some of
-them they smash down flat, and the sprout dies; but sometimes they
-fall so as just to bend a sprout over, or so that a little small
-sprout just growing is bound to grow up against the log as the
-sprout grows larger. These young trees are springy and bend easily.
-Of course the ones that are smashed down and broken off short are
-killed; we never hear anything more of them. But likely enough
-there are some young and hardy plants caught beneath the tops or
-branches of the fallen trees within a foot or two of the ground,
-and not much hurt but just held down. Sometimes these little trees
-are pressed flat to the ground, and when they are, they usually
-die. But if they are only bent over a few inches, or a foot or two
-from the ground, they don't always die. Instead of that they keep
-on growing, and of course the top of the growing tree keeps on
-reaching up all the time toward the light. No matter if it is bent
-flat, it tends to turn upward, so that all of it beyond the place
-where the dead tree is pressing on it grows straight, just like all
-the other trees around it. Then, after a while the dead stick which
-is holding the young tree down, rots, and at last disappears. The
-injured tree grows larger and larger, and at last gets to be a big
-tree; and there is then nothing to show how this big tree should
-have grown in such a bent, queer fashion."
-
-"Well now, Hugh, that's mighty interesting," said Jack, "and I
-ought to have worked it out for myself, for three or four times
-to-day I saw dead trees pressing little green sprouts over to one
-side; but I never thought about that being the reason for the bends
-in these big trees. The fact is, I never thought of them bending
-while the trees were young, but supposed it must be some accident
-or disease that had struck the trees after they were big."
-
-"Well," said Hugh, "you see it's all simple enough, if you
-understand it."
-
-"Simple!" said Jack, "Why it's simple as rolling off a log; but
-you've got to understand the reason."
-
-"Well," said Hugh, "you keep your eyes open as you ride through
-the timber, and you'll see the very thing I've been talking about,
-happening before your face all the time."
-
-The wind blew fiercely all day long, though when they were in
-the timber they hardly felt it, and only the sighing of the
-pines and occasionally the crash of some distant tree told of
-the force of the gale. They crossed Snake River about noon, and
-kept on southward. During a halt at the river all hands went to
-the fishing, and caught some splendid trout, which they promptly
-cooked and which gave them a delicious meal. A little more fishing
-furnished them with enough fish for two or three meals more, and
-Jack was hard at work trying to catch a big one that he had seen
-rise, when he saw two great shadows on the water, and looking up,
-saw only a few yards above him a pair of great sand-hill cranes.
-They were not in the least afraid, and flying on a little further,
-alighted in the meadow where they fed, walking about in most
-dignified fashion until the train started on again, and alarmed
-them.
-
-As they went into camp that afternoon at a little spring, Hugh said
-to the boys, "Now, look here; if one of you don't go out pretty
-soon and kill something, I'll have to do that myself. This camp
-needs fresh meat. Dried meat and back-fat is good; fish are good;
-but we want either a deer or an elk; or, better still, if you can
-find it, a buffalo; but I reckon these bison here in the mountains
-are a little too smart for any of us. They're pretty scarce, and
-they're pretty watchful."
-
-"Well," said Jack, "which one of us shall go? We can't both go,
-because one has got to stay and help drive the animals. I'll toss
-up with you, Joe, to see which shall hunt to-morrow morning."
-
-"All right," said Joe, "I'll toss up;" but as no one of them had a
-coin, Jack took a fresh chip, and rubbing some black earth on one
-side of it, said, "We'll call that black side heads, and the other
-tails; and Hugh will throw the chip. You call, Joe." Hugh tossed
-the chip into the air, and Joe called heads. But the chip came down
-the clean side up, and so Jack was to go hunting next morning.
-
-As soon as the animals were packed, Jack started off, keeping to
-the right of the trail and up the hill. He knew, of course, that
-at this time of the year the elk were likely to be found high up,
-and the deer, too; for the flies and mosquitoes were bad. The
-underbrush was thick, and there were many marshy places, and once
-this hillside had been covered with a great forest, for it was
-strewn with logs. The underbrush seemed higher and thicker than he
-had been accustomed to, and he saw many sorts of plants that he
-did not remember to have seen before; and at last it struck him
-that perhaps as he was now on the western side of the Continental
-Divide, the rain-fall might be greater, and that this might make a
-difference in the vegetation. Willow and alders, and other brush,
-made riding rather difficult, and besides that, the hillsides
-grew steeper and steeper, until at last Jack dismounted, and
-clambering up on foot, left Pawnee to follow, as he had long ago
-been trained to do. Getting up on a high ridge, bald now, though
-once forest-grown, for the ground was strewn with great charred and
-rotting tree-trunks, long before killed by fire, he followed the
-ridge toward higher land, and gradually climbing, at last reached a
-commanding height, from which he saw the beautiful Jackson's Lake,
-and its lovely surroundings.
-
-To the eastward the Red Mountain Ridge, rising above him, cut off
-the view, but northeast he could see the valley of Snake River,
-broad near at hand, but narrowing further off, until the mountains,
-closing in, hid the silver ribbon of the stream's course. To the
-west were the splendid gray and white masses of the Teton range,
-low and rounded toward the north, with long easy ridges of moderate
-steepness, and crowned with great fields of snow. Toward the
-southward the mountains became more and more abrupt, until at last
-the highest peak of all, Jack knew must be the Grand Teton. From
-this pinnacle the ridge gradually sank away again, becoming lower
-and lower in the blue and misty distance. Immediately under the
-ridge, and south of where Jack stood, was Jackson's Lake. He had
-often heard Hugh speak of Jackson's Hole and Jackson's Lake, spots
-for many years hardly known to white men, and about which most
-marvelous stories were told. Here, men used to say--the miners that
-the streams were paved with nuggets of gold, the trappers that the
-rivers and forests abounded in fur, the hunters that game was so
-abundant and so tame that there was always plenty to eat, and the
-camp never starved; and now this wonderful region lay before him.
-
-And yet he knew that within the past few years many people had
-passed through this place. He knew that the miners had washed the
-sands of the rivers, but found that they did not pay; that trappers
-had caught the beaver and the marten, and had soon trapped almost
-all of them. Now it was for him to find whether the game was as
-plenty as had been said.
-
-At all events, Jackson's Lake with the wide meadows that surrounded
-it, and the superb mountains that walled it in on one side, made
-this a lovely spot. The lake shone in the sunlight like a sheet
-of silver, and was dotted with pine-clad islands. On the west its
-waters flowed close beneath the great mountains which rose above
-it, but on the other three sides a belt of forest grew close to
-the water, and back of this belt, broad meadow lands, with groups
-of trees and low rounded clumps of willows, looked almost like a
-park. Further to the eastward bare ridges rose higher and higher,
-forming the foot-hills of the main range, and still further to the
-east and southeast were massive mountains, more distant--and so
-seeming lower--than the Teton Range, but which were the Continental
-Divide. Jack looked, and looked, and enjoyed this beautiful view;
-but after a little he realized that time was passing, and that he
-must move on, and do his hunting, and get to camp.
-
-He crossed the ridge, and began to ride down the side of the
-mountain toward the south, following the crest of a hog-back, which
-would take him down to the valley of the lake by a gentle slope.
-Below, and to his left, was a narrow valley, in which stood green
-timber, and among the green timber much that was dead and much that
-was down.
-
-
-
-
-Chapter IX
-
-AN ELK HUNT UNDER THE TETONS
-
-
-He was riding along slowly, letting Pawnee make his own way among
-the loose rocks and tree-trunks, when he caught sight of an animal
-standing with its tail toward him, in a little opening among the
-trees. For an instant he thought it was a buckskin horse, and
-the idea flashed through his mind that there must be a camp down
-there. Almost before the thought had taken form, the animal moved
-a little, and he saw that it was an elk. He slipped off his horse
-on the side furthest from the animal, and led Pawnee out of sight
-behind a clump of pines, and left him there. Then he crept back
-to the ridge. In the timber below he soon made out half-a-dozen
-elk, and as he watched, he could see quite a large bunch of cows
-and calves. He lay there, watching and waiting. The drop down the
-hill into the valley was very steep, and he was hoping that the elk
-might move into some position where he would not have to go down to
-them. They seemed uneasy and suspicious, and presently something
-startled them, and they ran a little way, and then stopped, looking
-back up the valley. Two big heifers stood almost side by side
-facing opposite ways, with their shoulders close together, and
-their heads in such position that their necks seemed to cross.
-Jack raised his gun and took a careful sight at the necks, just
-below the heads, and pulled the trigger. One of the cows dropped
-instantly, while the other, standing a moment to look, turned
-and ran off. He heard the elk crashing through the timber of the
-valley, and then saw them climbing the bald hills on the other
-side, stopping every little while to look back, and at last walking
-slowly off over the hills.
-
-A convenient side ridge gave Pawnee a good road down to where the
-cow had fallen, but she had rolled far down the hill, and finally
-had stopped on a little level place. She was quite dead. The animal
-was rather large for Jack to handle, but with some trouble he
-managed to cut off her hams and sirloins, and tying the two hams
-together by the gambrel joints, he balanced them on his saddle, and
-then tying the sirloins on behind, set out on foot for camp. There
-was much scrambling up steep hillsides, and down others quite as
-steep, and some working through the thick underbrush, before he
-came out into the open lake valley. Here progress was more rapid.
-Jack walked swiftly, and Pawnee followed close behind. After a time
-he came on the trail made by the pack train, some hours before,
-and hurrying along this, presently saw in the distance what looked
-like a house. Before he reached it, however, the trail that he was
-following turned sharply to the right, and led down toward the
-river, two or three miles below the lake.
-
-As he approached the tall cottonwood timber, which he supposed grew
-on the shores of the river, he saw the horses feeding close to it,
-and before long the cone of the lodge showed through the leaves,
-and a little later he stopped by the fire.
-
-"Good boy," said Hugh. "I'm mighty glad to get that meat. That'll
-keep us going for quite a while, and now that we've got fresh meat,
-and dried meat and fish, we're bound to live well."
-
-"Animal's in good order, too," he continued, as he began to lift
-the meat from the saddle. "I expect you picked out a heifer, didn't
-you?"
-
-"Well," said Jack, "I tried to, but I wasn't sure that it wasn't an
-old cow until I put a knife into her. The only thing I was sure of
-was that she had no calf." "Well," said Hugh, "it's a nice piece of
-meat, and I'm mighty glad you got it."
-
-"What's that house that I see up there, Hugh? Nobody lives here
-now, does there?"
-
-"No," said Hugh, "I reckon that's some kind of a shelter or stable,
-built by hunters or prospectors, for their horses in fly-time.
-Flies are pretty bad here now, and I reckon close about this lake
-the greenheads must be enough to drive the horses crazy. I noticed
-to-day when we were crossing some points of that meadow up above
-that they were bad. If it hadn't been for that, I reckon we'd have
-camped up there by the lake. It's an awful sightly spot, but there
-were too many flies."
-
-Supper was almost ready, and they feasted royally that night on
-trout and the fat sirloins of the elk; and after the meal was over,
-it was pleasant to sit round the big camp-fire that Jack and Joe
-built out in front of the lodge, and watch the blaze, and listen to
-the murmur of the river as it hurried over the stones, just beyond
-the camp. Every stick tossed on the burning pile sent a great cloud
-of sparks soaring upward to disappear among the dark green foliage
-of the spruces, which here grew among the taller cottonwoods. The
-warmth of the fire was grateful; the willows and cottonwoods and
-spruces all about their camp sheltered them from the strong wind
-which still blew down the valley; and Jack, as he lay stretched out
-on the ground between Joe and Hugh, thought that he never could
-have a happier time than that very moment.
-
-"Now, boys," said Hugh, "I don't know how you feel about it, but
-it strikes me this is a terrible nice place to stop for a day or
-two. This is a good camp, and these mountains right opposite to us
-are things I like to look at. What do you say to our stopping here,
-say for one day, anyhow; and maybe to-morrow we'll take a little
-ride across the river, and get closer to these mountains, and see
-something of what they look like. I'd like mighty well to look at
-them long enough to kind o' carry a remembrance of them back with
-me to the ranch."
-
-"Well," said Jack, "let's do that. There's no reason for our
-hurrying; we've got plenty of grub, and I think we'd all like to
-stay here for one day, anyhow."
-
-"Now, there's two things we can do," said Hugh. "We ain't made up
-our minds how we'll go home; but we can cross the range in a whole
-lot of different places. We can either follow down Snake River for
-a way, and then work up one of the creeks, and go over and strike
-the head of Wind River, and follow that down, or we can go back to
-the park, and then cut across, and get down onto Stinking Water,
-and then go back on the prairie. My idea is that we'll do better to
-keep on south, and try to go straight on our course. We can either
-go up Buffalo Fork, and then strike across to the head of the Wind
-River, and follow that down; or go down and follow up the Gros
-Ventre, and get across some way there. We don't have to make up our
-minds to-day; we can settle that to-morrow night. Let's agree that
-we'll stop here to-morrow, and then to-morrow night decide what
-we'll do."
-
-"All right," said both boys.
-
-When the three friends got up next morning, and went to the
-stream to wash, they could see nothing of the great range beneath
-which they were camped, for the tall spruce trees which grew on
-the opposite bank cut off the view of everything beyond. After
-breakfast they saddled up and having picketed two of the pack
-horses, set out to cross the river, and to get nearer to the
-mountains. The river was wide, and so deep that the water came
-almost up to the saddle blankets, but they crossed comfortably
-enough, and riding through the open dry timber of the bottom,
-before long were approaching the high bluffs which formed the first
-terrace above the river. In the bottom were many tracks of deer
-and elk, some of the deer tracks quite fresh; and they almost rode
-over a huge old porcupine, which waddled awkwardly to one side,
-and then stopped among some low rose bushes, with its head between
-its forefeet, its quills erect, and its tail thrashing about in a
-threatening way. Jack stopped his horse and said to Hugh:
-
-"Hugh, is there anything in that story that porcupines throw their
-quills? I've heard lots of people say it is so, and then other
-people say it isn't."
-
-Hugh drew his horse up, and turning in his saddle said, "Why no,
-son, there's nothing in that; though I've heard plenty of men who
-ought to know a heap better say that there was. Take a stick and go
-right up close to that fellow, and poke him with it, and then bring
-it to me."
-
-Jack picked up a dead branch, and going to the porcupine, poked him
-in the sides and back, and when he did this the porcupine thrashed
-his tail about more vigorously than ever, and two or three times
-struck the stick. Leaving him, Jack went to Hugh, carrying the
-stick in his hand, and Hugh said, "Look at the end of that stick
-now, and see those quills." The end of the stick was pierced by a
-dozen or twenty sharp, strong quills, and Jack, taking hold of one
-and trying to pull it out, found that the point was firmly fastened
-in the wood, so that it required quite a little effort to pull it
-out.
-
-"Now, son," said Hugh, "a porcupine, as you have seen, is slow, and
-can't run away. His back and sides and tail are covered with these
-quills, which are mighty sharp, and which have little stickers
-pointing back toward the root, so that if a quill gets fast in the
-flesh, it is a very hard matter to pull it out again. If a quill
-gets stuck in an animal's head or foot, it keeps working forward
-all the time; it never works backward and comes out; it has to go
-through to the other side. Most animals know that it isn't good to
-fool with a porcupine. The only way to kill him is to turn him
-over on his back, and get at his throat and belly, which are not
-covered with quills. When a porcupine sees an animal coming he
-holds his body close to the ground, makes his quills stand up all
-over him, and thrashes around with his tail, which is pretty well
-covered with quills too. His tail is strong, and he can hit a hard
-blow with it; and so you see he's pretty well defended. The quills
-are not set deep in the skin; they are loose, and they pull out
-mighty easy; you see that just by poking the porcupine you got that
-stick full of quills. Sometimes when he thrashes hard with his tail
-he may hit a piece of wood, or may knock loose some of the quills
-on his tail so that they may fly a little distance; but as for
-throwing them any distance from his body, or with any force, why he
-can't do it.
-
-"I have had dogs that would tackle porcupines, and when they did,
-it was a terrible job to pull the quills out of them."
-
-"Well," said Jack, "I'm glad to hear all that I've been told of
-dogs tackling porcupines, up in the Adirondacks, but I never saw
-one that had been pierced by quills."
-
-"Most dogs," said Hugh, "soon learn never to bother porcupines,
-but some seem never to learn, and will go for one every time they
-see it. Bears sometimes tackle them, and so do lynx and panthers,
-but they say the greatest animal of all to kill a porcupine is a
-fisher. I've seen two or three panthers with their jaws full of
-quills. I've heard people say that the fisher kills them by turning
-them over on their backs and then jumping onto the belly, but I
-never saw this done. What I have seen is fishers with lots of
-quills in their bodies: some in the legs, some in the belly, and
-some in the sides. And the Indians say that these quills don't
-bother them at all; that is to say, that a fisher full of quills
-don't swell up the way a dog or a panther does. The porcupine is
-a pretty stupid beast, but its effect on its neighbors is quite
-interesting."
-
-Jack listened with much attention to this lesson in natural
-history, and they mounted and rode on again.
-
-Soon they came to a great slough, evidently an old beaver meadow,
-and as Hugh drew up his horse and looked at it, he shook his
-head:--"Too soft for us to cross, I reckon, we'll have to go round
-some other way. There's plenty of sloughs and mud-holes in there
-where our horses would go out of sight."
-
-They turned northward, and for the next two hours were occupied
-in trying to make their way out to the high prairie. At frequent
-intervals they came to what looked like a tongue of hard dry land
-extending out to the bluffs, but after following it for a little
-distance they found at its end a mud-hole, which obliged them to
-turn back and take another road. At length they reached a strip
-of hard ground which led them to the bluffs; and just before they
-rode up the steep ascent, Hugh's horse started from the ground a
-brood of grouse, which scattered in all directions, many of them
-alighting on the willows and spruce branches close to them. They
-were singularly tame, almost as much so as the fool hens they had
-seen farther north, and Jack rode up to within three or four feet
-of one, and then reached out his gun to touch it, but before the
-muzzle was within a foot of the bird, it flew away.
-
-When they reached the higher prairie they rode off toward the
-range, which was now plainly to be seen. There were three principal
-peaks, the names of which Hugh gave them. One, he said, was Mount
-Moran, a great square-topped mass of granite, with two or three
-vast snow or ice banks on its north face. To the south of that were
-the three pinnacles of the Tetons, whose slender summits ran far
-up into the blue sky. The prairie over which they were now riding
-was uneven:--here cut by dry, grassy, ancient water-ways, there
-with mounds of great extent rising above the general level. There
-was much gravel--some of it very large--which looked as if it might
-have been carried down by the water. Long ridges composed wholly
-of this gravel ran for long distances out from the foot of the
-range, and were now for the most part bare of timber, having been
-burned over. On some of them the fire had spared many of the pines,
-and young aspen timber grew on their slopes. The terraces of the
-river's flood-plain rose one above another, and on the highest of
-all, on the west side, were groups of evergreen trees, and now and
-then a single pine standing alone in the wide sage-plain. Scattered
-about over the prairie were many antelope.
-
-They rode on toward the mountains, trying to get up high enough
-so as to look down on Jackson's Lake, which runs in close to the
-foot of Mount Moran; but the ridges became higher and higher, more
-and more timber grew on them, and cut off the view, so that at
-length they gave up the effort and turned off to one side to ride
-through the timber. Here were many fresh elk tracks and trails,
-some made the night before, and some since daylight; and here,
-quite unexpectedly, as they rode over a ridge a little higher than
-any that they had yet passed, a fine view was had of the southern
-end of Jackson's Lake. It seemed to wind and twist about among its
-points and islands, and sent out long and narrow finger-like bays
-into the hills in a most curious way. A little further on they saw
-from a hilltop another lake, not nearly so large as Jackson's,
-but still perhaps two miles long. It was surrounded by dense
-forest, and reflected the great peaks which overhung it. Here they
-dismounted for a while to look at the range, which was now plainly
-seen.
-
-"Big mountains, ain't they, son?" said Hugh, as they sat there
-looking up at them.
-
-"Yes, Hugh," said Jack, "they're awful big, and how bare and gray
-they are. There seems to be a little timber in small patches, but
-except for that, there doesn't seem to be anything growing on them
-at all; they are just rocks with snow on top and in the ravines."
-
-"Well," said Hugh, "I expect for the most part that rock is so
-steep that the snow can't lie there. Even if the wind don't blow,
-just as soon as any weight of snow falls on the rocks it slips off.
-
-"Have you got your glasses with you, son?" he continued, and when
-Jack had handed them to him, he looked through them and said: "I
-thought so. Do you know, son, that snow up there in those highest
-ravines isn't snow at all, it's ice; just like them glaciers that
-we have up there in the mountains to the north. Look through the
-glasses, and you can see the cracks on the lower border, and you
-can see too that it is blue, and not white like snow."
-
-Jack and Joe both looked through the glasses and saw what Hugh
-meant, and both were reminded of the masses of ice that they had
-seen in the mountains of the north, the year before.
-
-It was pleasant sitting in the warm sun and looking up at this
-wonderful scenery, but at last they caught up their horses, and
-mounted and rode back to the camp. As they were going along side by
-side, down the wide point of a ridge, a great brown deer bounced
-out from an aspen thicket on Joe's side and ran down the ravine.
-Joe sprang from his horse and raised his gun to shoot, but just as
-he did so she sprang into a little gully, so that Joe could see
-only her ears as she raced along. She followed the ravine down and
-was not seen again.
-
-Hugh and Jack both laughed at Joe, and told him that he should have
-stayed on his horse, for from their point of view on horseback, the
-doe's body had been in sight for quite time enough to shoot.
-
-When they reached the level bottom, they rode out close to the
-river, and keeping along the bank found firm ground all the way to
-the camp. There remained still some hours of daylight, and both
-boys got out their lines and began to fish, catching a number of
-fine and heavy trout. Just as they were about to go to camp with
-their catch, a flock of seven wild geese flew up the river, calling
-loudly, and after they had passed a little beyond the boys, Joe
-began to honk in response, and presently the great birds turned
-about and came back, flying directly over the boys, looking down
-at them, as if to see who it was that was talking to them. The air
-was cool and damp after dark and they sat about the fire in the
-lodge. A great horned owl a little way down the river was hooting
-regularly, and Joe said, "We're going to have a storm."
-
-"Yes," said Hugh, "I hear him now, and I heard him last night. I
-reckon we're going to have change of weather."
-
-"What do you mean, Hugh?" said Jack, "has the owl anything to do
-with the weather?"
-
-"Well no, son, I don't know that he has; but some of the Indians
-say that if you hear an owl calling it means a storm's coming."
-
-It was raining the next morning when Jack thrust his head from
-under his blankets, and as the fire had not been started, and
-nobody seemed to be moving, he knew that this day also would be
-spent in camp. When he went out of the lodge the ground was covered
-with an inch of very wet snow, and the weather seemed to be trying
-to make up its mind whether it would rain or no. Big wet flakes
-were falling in a mixture of rain and snow, and moisture was
-everywhere.
-
-After breakfast, Hugh cut some crotches and poles, and with the
-ropes and two of the mantas made a very good shelter, under which
-they built an outdoor fire. By this they sat for a long time,
-discussing various matters, and then, since the rain had stopped,
-Jack went down to the stream and began to fish. He caught a few
-fish weighing from three quarters of a pound to a pound, and there
-were enough of them to make it interesting. The small ones seemed
-to trouble his hook very little, and one or two little ones that he
-caught he shook off before getting them to shore. Suddenly, after a
-long cast that he had made out toward the middle of the stream, a
-huge fish rose to his fly, but in its eagerness, missed and sprang
-over the fly showing its full length out of the water. This was
-such a fish as Jack had not seen before, and he was very anxious to
-get it. He cast again over the same spot, and this time drew in his
-line a little more slowly. The great fish rose again, and just at
-the right moment Jack struck, and had him fast.
-
-For a moment the fish did nothing, but then came a fight the like
-of which Jack had never witnessed. The fish made a strong rush
-toward the deepest water of the rapid, and twice on his way there
-he sprang into the air, shaking his head savagely to rid himself of
-the steel that was biting his jaw. Then he turned about and rushed
-back toward the bank, again throwing himself out of the water. Jack
-was excited, but was trying to keep cool. Whenever the fish gave
-him an opportunity he took in line, and when the fish ran he gave
-him as little as possible.
-
-Suddenly the trout started down the river at great speed, so fast
-that Jack was afraid to check him, and started racing after him,
-running over the slippery stones of the beach, and through the
-pools of water left by the river. Presently the fish stopped, and
-refused to move, and Jack recovered all the line that he could, and
-then began to try to move the fish. Now it began to give a series
-of tugging jerks on the line, as if it were bending itself from
-side to side in the water; then it began to throw itself over and
-over, as if trying to twist the line; and then it would rush off,
-as if striving to break it. As the splendid fish grew tired, Jack
-worked it nearer and nearer to the beach; but he had no net and
-of course could not lift it from the water. After looking about a
-little he found a place where the beach was shelving, and laying
-down his rod, he drew the fish out by the leader and soon had it
-safely in his hand. It was a handsome fish, deep and thick, and yet
-graceful in all its lines, and it seemed to Jack as big as a North
-River shad. As soon as it was killed, Jack took his rod and started
-back to the camp for he wished to show them there the biggest trout
-that he had ever seen.
-
-White clouds hung low over the valley and hid the mountains on
-either side; but as Jack walked along the beach the western sky
-grew lighter, and for a few moments the sun struggled to shine
-through the clouds. Then suddenly, far down the valley the white
-wall that shut out the view broke away, and Jack could see the
-great mountain mass of the Teton Range. He stopped and gazed,
-waiting for the rent to close up again. Through it he could see,
-like a picture in its frame, the mountains, not dark and gray
-as they had been yesterday, but white now, in all the purity of
-new-fallen snow. As he looked, the break in the clouds moved
-rapidly northward, exposing one mountain after another, each
-seeming more beautiful than the one seen just before. A wreath of
-mist hung around and concealed the needle peak of the Grand Teton,
-adding to, rather than taking away from its height. The rift in the
-clouds passed northward, and after it had shown him Mount Moran, it
-closed again and the white vapor cut off the view. Jack had seen
-the glories of the Tetons, snow-clad. He returned to camp.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER X
-
-TRAILING BLACK-TAILS
-
-
-It was pleasant that night after supper was over, as they lay about
-the bright fire in the lodge. During the afternoon, while Jack had
-been fishing, Joe had split fine a lot of dry cottonwood sticks,
-and a good pile of them lay within the lodge door, just to its
-left. The fire blazed and crackled merrily and the draft was good,
-so that there was no smoke even in the top of the lodge.
-
-Joe said to Jack, "Jack, have you seen all this old beaver work up
-north of the camp?"
-
-"No," said Jack, "I have seen plenty of small beaver cuttings.
-There have been lots of beaver here, but I haven't seen any big
-work."
-
-"Well," said Joe, "you'd better go up fifty yards from the camp,
-and you'll see there bigger trees cut down by the beaver than I've
-ever seen, and I've seen some beaver work in my day. Why, there's
-cottonwood logs there cut down by the beaver that are bigger round
-than my body, and I believe they're more than a foot through. You
-surely ought to see them."
-
-"Well," said Jack, "I will in the morning."
-
-"This used to be a great place for fur, didn't it Hugh?"
-
-"Yes," said Hugh, "I expect when the white men first came in here
-that beaver were awful plenty. Wherever I've been since I came into
-this valley I've seen lots of old work but not much new work. All
-the same, these sticks that Joe is talking about are not very old;
-they were cut down only a few years ago. I guess 'twas a great fur
-country. But, Lord! I've told you about the stories that people
-used to tell about Jackson's Lake. They used to say that pretty
-nearly everything good in the mountains was to be found here, and
-plenty of it.
-
-"Do you know, boys," Hugh continued, "I've about made up my mind
-what we'd better do? Now, we don't know the country here, none of
-us, but I expect we can find our way around pretty well with the
-pack-train. I think the best thing we can do is to go back to that
-last big creek that we crossed, and follow that up to its head;
-then cross the mountains there, and get over onto Wind River;
-and then we can follow Wind River down; and then over and strike
-Sweetwater, and follow Sweetwater down to the Platte; and then, you
-know, we're pretty near home. What do you say? Would either of you
-rather go any other way, or will you leave it that way?"
-
-The boys sat silent for a little while, and then Joe said, "I think
-it will be good to do as Hugh says; he is the leader, and we will
-follow him."
-
-"I think so, too," said Jack. "Neither of us boys knows anything
-about the country, and we want to do just what you think is best,
-Hugh."
-
-"Well," said Hugh, "I guess that is best, and if you say so, we'll
-do it; and we'll start to-morrow morning if the weather is good
-and the things are dry."
-
-"All right," said both boys.
-
-The next morning saw the little train following its back trail up
-Snake River for a few miles, when Hugh turned off to the right, and
-entered the valley of a great stream which rushed down from the Red
-Mountain Range. The hills were low and rounded and composed of sand
-and gravel, covered with grass and sage-brush. On either side, from
-time to time, the stream had cut into the hills and washed away
-the gravel, and its bed was full of huge boulders; so that it was
-necessary for them to keep back on the ridge, at some distance from
-the water. The river was so large and along it there were so many
-evidences of a vast body of water running down through this valley
-in the spring, that it seemed evident that it must be a very long
-stream, and must drain a wide area of country. Before they had gone
-very far, the sun, which had been shining, went behind clouds; it
-began to rain hard; and before long they began to get wet. Early in
-the day, therefore, Hugh drew up his horse in the shelter of some
-spruces on a little bench about thirty feet above the valley, and
-said, "Let's camp, boys, and get out of this wet." It took but a
-little time to put up the lodge, to unsaddle, get things covered
-and a fire in the lodge, and also one outside under a shelter of
-manta, so that they were soon dry and comfortable again. Jack tried
-the fishing, but the fish would not bite. The rain continued, and
-by the middle of the afternoon had changed to snow, and before dark
-the ground was white. When they went to bed at night the snow was
-still falling and the weather was growing colder.
-
-The next morning the snow had stopped, but it was two or three
-inches deep on the ground. Everything was wet, and it looked as if
-it might snow again at any time. Jack got tired of sitting round
-the fire, and watching Hugh fill his pipe, and light it and smoke
-it out, and then fill and light it again, and presently he proposed
-to Joe that they should go out and try to kill a deer. Joe was
-ready and they started. For a short distance, they followed the
-trail up the river, and then turning to the left, took the first
-ridge and began to climb the hill on the north side of the valley.
-It was pretty wet. It had begun to rain again, and the snow was
-damp, and under the snow there seemed to be an inch or two of
-water. When they had to pass through willows and other underbrush,
-these wet the upper parts of their bodies. The ground was soft and
-slippery, and the down timber and the loose stones made walking and
-climbing quite hard work. Nevertheless, they pushed on, and having
-reached the top of the ridge, could see beyond other ridges toward
-which they climbed.
-
-They crossed one or two elk tracks, made since the snow had stopped
-falling, but the animals were going pretty fast and they did not
-follow them. A few deer tracks, made while the snow was falling,
-tempted them; but they did not follow them and continued to climb.
-The higher they went the harder it seemed to rain, and every little
-while a heavy fog would rise from the valley, and creeping slowly
-along the mountains would shut out from sight one hilltop after
-another, until it reached them and hid everything from their sight.
-There was a little breeze blowing from the west, and these fogs did
-not last long; but while they were about them the boys could only
-stand still and wait for the mist to lift.
-
-As they climbed they saw a good many birds: flickers, robins, and
-blue snow-birds, as well as some other western birds that Jack did
-not know.
-
-The boys climbed hill after hill for several hours, but saw nothing
-but tracks, and none of these seemed worth following. At last Jack
-turned to Joe and said, "What do you say, Joe, shall we go any
-further? It's pretty cold, and we can't see far, and perhaps we
-might as well go down the hill again and get back to camp."
-
-"Well," said Joe, "it's pretty cold and wet up here and we don't
-see much."
-
-They turned and followed the ridge they were on for some little
-distance, trying to see down into the valley, and to determine
-just where the camp was. As they were doing this, all at once
-the fog lifted, and Jack saw, a little way before them, a green
-timbered ridge leading down into the valley, pretty near where the
-camp should be. As he looked down into the valley, Jack heard Joe
-whisper, "Hold on!" Jack stopped, slowly turned his head and threw
-a cartridge into his gun, and then stood motionless; for over the
-crest of the ridge just above them had risen the horns, head and
-body of an enormous black-tailed buck. Almost at once, two others,
-much smaller, followed him, and in a moment more two others, one
-nearly as large as the leader, and the other smaller, came up to
-the top of the ridge and looked over. They were a long way off,
-perhaps three hundred yards, and neither boy dared move for fear of
-startling them, for two or three jumps would have taken them out
-of sight. The great leader had seen the boys at once, but could
-not make out what they were, and perhaps for ten minutes he stood
-there and watched. He was not alarmed or suspicious, but these
-two upright objects, which might be stumps or might be something
-else, excited his curiosity, and he kept looking at them. The deer
-stood on the very crest of the ridge, with only a white sky for
-a background; so that the outline of his graceful form and large
-branching horns was plainly visible.
-
-While he stood there watching, the other deer wandered about,
-now taking a bite of grass and again giving a long look over the
-country. One of the smallest came a few steps down the face of the
-ridge to a low pine, three or four feet in height, against which he
-began to rub his horns and head, just as a deer or an elk does when
-ridding the antlers of the velvet, or, as it is termed, "shaking."
-The large one, next in size to the leader, came still further down
-the bluff and began to feed at a bush that grew there. A third, the
-smallest of all, was very playful and frisked about almost as a
-fawn might do.
-
-At length, after his long, long stare, during which the boys
-scarcely breathed, the big leader seemed satisfied. He shook
-himself, and then turned and gave a long look to the east and one
-to the west; then he lowered his head, took a bite of some weed,
-and stepping proudly along the ridge for a few yards, turned away
-and walked out of sight. While he was doing this, two of the young
-deer, like boys when the schoolmaster's back is turned and they
-feel that they can begin to play, backed away from each other, and
-then charged each other, coming together vigorously, head to head.
-It did not seem to be done angrily, but rather in sport, and one of
-them, being evidently much the stronger of the two, as he was the
-larger, pushed the other a few feet backward, when the smaller one
-sprang lightly out of the way, and both turned and walked off after
-the big buck.
-
-Four of the deer had now moved out of sight, and there remained
-only the large one feeding on the hillside. A couple of dead
-trees, one leaning against the other, stood sixty or seventy yards
-in front of the boys, between them and the deer, and it seemed
-possible by moving up behind these to approach within rifle-shot.
-He was busily eating, and when he had his head down the boys
-whispered to each other. Jack said, "Let us sneak up behind those
-trees, and we can get near enough to kill him, I guess."
-
-"Better wait," said Joe, "pretty soon he'll go off over the hill,
-and then we can follow him, and get one sure."
-
-But Jack had not yet learned the patience which makes an Indian
-so certain of his game; he began to make a slow approach, but had
-taken only a few steps when suddenly the deer stopped feeding,
-looked about him, walked briskly up to the top of the ridge,
-and then pausing for a moment to see where his companions were,
-followed them over the ridge and out of sight.
-
-At last the coast was clear; the boys hurried toward the ridge,
-and clambered up its steep face with breathless haste. When they
-reached the crest they cautiously looked over, but saw nothing,
-and still as they slowly advanced in the direction which the deer
-seemed to have taken, the game was not seen. They were just about
-to go back and take the deers' tracks, when suddenly, without an
-instant's warning, a mountain hurricane of hail, rain and snow
-swept down upon them, blotting from view every object save those
-directly at their feet. The wind blew cold, and the rain and hail
-pelted them. There was no shelter, and all they could do was to
-turn their backs to the blast and stand there waiting. The storm
-lasted but a few moments, and as soon as it was over they started
-back, and soon crossed the tracks of the deer, not far from the
-ridge. All had been walking slowly, except the last one, who was
-trotting to catch up with the others. The trail led over the
-rolling ground, toward two little groups of spruces, and when the
-boys saw these, and could not see the deer on the open ground
-beyond, they looked at each other and nodded, each feeling sure
-that the animals would be found in this timber.
-
-They were still a hundred yards from the nearest clump of trees
-when Joe's eye caught sight of something moving just beyond them,
-and almost at the same time Jack saw something dark move against
-the snow. They made themselves very small, and keeping the thick
-foliage of the trees between themselves and the deer, crept
-carefully up almost to the timber. Suddenly, through a little
-opening in the branches, Jack saw three deer standing close
-together--the big leader and two of the yearlings. He wanted the
-leader, of course, and yet he could see only his head and neck,
-and hesitated to shoot at the neck, for he was chilled and shaking
-with the cold. However, he determined to risk it, and looking round
-at Joe saw that he was ready, and that he nodded. Jack fired, the
-leader disappeared, and a moment later four deer ran out over the
-snow, beyond the trees, and stopped; and as they turned to look
-back, Joe fired, and killed the other big deer.
-
-"Hurrah!" said Jack, and he shook Joe's hand, "we've surely got
-plenty of meat now."
-
-"Yes," said Joe, "good meat, too."
-
-They found the big leader lying on the snow just beyond the trees,
-his neck broken, and the other big deer not more than fifty yards
-beyond him.
-
-"Now, Jack," said Joe, "I tell you what we'd better do: you go
-back to camp and get two pack horses, and fetch 'em up here, and
-I'll butcher these deer, and then we can take 'em back to the camp
-to-night. We don't want to make two trips."
-
-"That's so," said Jack, "I'll either go back for the horses or
-butcher, whichever you like."
-
-"No," said Joe, "you go back, and when I get through butchering
-I'll make a little fire here and dry off, and wait for you."
-
-"All right," said Jack, "I'll do it. I don't believe it'll take me
-very long to get back to camp, and I'll be back here in an hour or
-two, anyhow."
-
-He at once started, and was soon following the green timbered
-ridge down to the stream. When he reached there he found that
-camp was only a short distance further down the creek, and he was
-soon standing by the fire. Hugh had heard the shots, and was not
-surprised when Jack told them that they had two deer. Jack went
-out to look up the horses, and soon returned with two of them, and
-putting saddles on them, mounted one, and rode off up the hill
-leading the other.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XI
-
-TRACKS IN THE SNOW
-
-
-Meantime Joe had proceeded with his butchering and after he had
-finished, gathered some wood and made himself a little fire. It
-took some time to do this, for almost everywhere the wood was wet;
-but by looking carefully he found some dry branches that were
-sheltered by the foliage above them, and others that lay under a
-fallen tree, and presently he had a good fire lighted, and one
-that was so strong that he could throw wet wood on it and it would
-soon dry and burn. He built his fire in a sheltered place, and the
-light breeze drifted the smoke off down the stream. Before long he
-was warm and dry. After he had waited a while, he went out beyond
-the trees and looked off toward the ridge where Jack had gone,
-to see whether he was not yet coming back, but he saw nothing. A
-little later he went out again and Jack was not yet in sight, but
-as he turned about he saw coming down the hill about half a mile
-off, thirteen elk, mostly cows and calves, but one spikehorn, and
-following last of all and keeping the others together a monstrous
-bull with a great pair of horns. Of course when he saw them Joe
-stood still. The elk had come down from some higher hill, and
-when they came to where the snow was not very deep they began to
-scatter out and feed. When most of them had passed behind the point
-of hill which backed the next ridge above the one Joe was on, he
-began to move very slowly and cautiously toward the shelter of a
-clump of trees. Every now and then, one of the old cows would lift
-her head, and as she munched the grass that she had just plucked,
-would look all around the horizon, and when she did so, Joe stood
-without moving a muscle. Then when all the heads were down again,
-he very slowly moved a little toward his cover. At last only one
-of the elk was in sight, and when she put her head down he could
-see nothing but her back and hips, and two or three steps took
-him out of sight even of these. Still he did not run, but walked
-slowly, watching closely the sky-line above him, for at any moment
-one of the elk might walk up there to look over the country. None
-appeared, however, and in a very few moments he was hidden by the
-trees.
-
-Now he did not know what to do. His first idea was to creep up to
-the ridge and kill some of the elk, but before he determined that
-he would do this he considered. He remembered how Hugh often spoke
-of not killing anything more than they needed to eat, and he knew
-that these deer that they had would last them for a long time.
-He did not wish to do anything that Hugh would not like, and so,
-instead of deciding that he would kill anything, he took his gun
-and walked over to the ridge, to look at the elk. He had crept up
-to the top of the hill and peered over, and was watching the elk
-feeding not far in front of him--half a dozen of them within easy
-rifle-range--when he heard a faint whoop behind him, and turning
-his head saw Jack coming with the pack-horses. Slowly creeping back
-a little way, Joe waved to him to come on, and to hurry, and Jack
-galloped the pack horses over to the foot of the ridge, and at a
-sign from Joe, dismounted. Then he crept up to Joe and they both
-lay there on the hill and watched the elk.
-
-It was a pretty sight, and an interesting one, too. The bull,
-although all the time feeding, seemed to keep close watch of his
-companions. Once in a while one of the cows would stray off to
-a little distance from the others, and the bull would walk over
-toward her, shaking his head as he approached, and when the cow saw
-this she turned back to the bunch and joined them again. Then the
-bull began to feed once more.
-
-"Watch him," said Joe, "he's a pretty good herder, isn't he? He
-won't let one of those cows wander away; he's afraid that somewhere
-there might be some other old bull looking for cows, that would
-take her and carry her off. Pretty smart at this time of year they
-are."
-
-While they were watching the herd as they fed along a little beyond
-them, presently some eddy of the wind brought their scent to the
-cows farthest down the stream, and they lifted up their heads,
-and looked for a moment; then turned and trotted swiftly away up
-the hill. As soon as they did this, the other cows began to look,
-and then to move off; but the bull seemed to understand at once
-that there was danger near at hand, and rushed around the cows,
-thrusting at them with his horns, so that in a moment they were
-all in motion, and swiftly trotting away. At the top of the hill
-the cows paused to look back; but the bull, which was laboring
-along behind, shook his head at them, and they began to run again.
-When the elk had disappeared, the boys rose to their feet, and then
-realized that they were both of them chattering with cold. The
-breeze was blowing harder now, and lying on the hillside exposed
-to it, they had both become chilled. They went down to the horses
-and took them over to where the deer lay and then built up the fire
-and got warm again. Then they packed the deer on the two horses,
-but the animals were so large that they could not lift them without
-cutting them up into quarters. At last the loads were arranged, the
-ropes tightened, and they started down the hill toward camp, which
-they reached just before dark.
-
-Supper was ready, and as soon as the boys had hung up their meat on
-the branches of a tree, and had washed their hands in the brook,
-they fell to eagerly. Not much was said during the meal, but after
-it had been cleared away and Hugh had filled his pipe and was
-sitting by the fire comfortably smoking, Jack said to him, "Hugh,
-we had a mighty nice view of a bunch of elk this afternoon, and
-watched them for quite a while, and saw the old bull gather up the
-cows and drive them away when they found that we were there."
-
-"Yes," said Hugh, "haven't you ever seen a bull do that before?"
-
-"No," said Jack, "I've seen plenty of elk but I never happened to
-see that."
-
-"Well," said Hugh, "you know the bull elk is mighty rough with his
-cows, after he has gathered them and got a bunch, and what is more,
-when he is looking for them in the early fall, just about this
-time, he is mighty systematic in the way he hunts for them. I've
-sat on a hill and seen an old bull hunt out a lot of ravines in the
-elk country just as systematically as a cow-puncher would hunt them
-out for cattle. He makes a regular business of it, and after he's
-got them together he don't allow any straggling, and if a cow don't
-mind what he says, and he can catch her, he gives her a terrible
-thumping with those old horns of his."
-
-"Well, Hugh, did you ever see two bulls fight?"
-
-"Yes," said Hugh, "I've seen 'em do that a good many times. I
-reckon I've told you about that before. They don't fight quickly;
-they're not active like an antelope when they're fighting: but
-they're mighty powerful, and they come together pretty hard, and
-then they just push and push, and at last, if the footing is good,
-the biggest one is pretty sure to push the other out of the way,
-and if the smaller one doesn't hop round pretty lively, he gets
-a good punch with the horns. I've heard tell of elk killing each
-other when they fought; but I never saw anything like that, and I
-never even saw an elk get cut up with the horns of an animal that
-he was fighting with. Of course I never had a chance to look close
-at many elk that I saw fighting, but I never could see any blood
-or any cuts. An elk-hide is pretty thick, and I guess they just
-scratch and bruise each other.
-
-"I've heard of elk-horns being locked, same as deer-horns often
-are, but I never myself saw but one pair; they were locked and you
-could not pull them apart. I heard that some chap bought them, up
-on the Missouri River, to send back east to some museum."
-
-"Well, I tell you, Hugh," said Jack, "I don't think much of elk,
-anyhow, except to eat. You remember that tame one we had down at
-the ranch? There wasn't anything interesting or nice about him; he
-was awkward and clumsy and mean. Of course he looked nice, but that
-was about all."
-
-"No," said Hugh, "that's so; elk meat is good, but that's about all
-elk are good for--to eat."
-
-The next morning the sun came out bright and strong, and the snow
-began to melt rapidly. Lines were strung among the trees, and all
-the blankets, ropes and saddles, which had been more or less wet
-during the last day or two, were hung up to dry. The flesh of the
-deer was sliced into thin flakes, and hung up on scaffolds made by
-Joe and Hugh, and under this a small fire was made, and the smoke
-passing under the flakes of meat partially dried it. The hams and
-saddle of one of the deer were kept for fresh meat.
-
-"I'd like to get off this afternoon," said Hugh, toward midday. "Of
-course it's early in the season yet, and no heavy snow is likely to
-fall; but often we have a storm late in September that might stop
-us for a week, and I'd be pleased if we could get over the ridge
-before that comes. We must start as soon as these things get dry,
-and as soon as that meat will do to pack; it's pretty fat, and it
-won't dry fast in this kind of weather; this air is too damp."
-
-In the effort to hurry up the drying process they built a large
-fire near the wet things that were hung up, and as the heat from
-the fire and from the sun grew strong, the steam rose from them. A
-little after noon, Hugh, who had been inspecting the things, said,
-"Come on, now; let's saddle up. The robes and blankets are dry, and
-we'll shove this meat in a sack and give it another steaming when
-we get to a good place. The weather is cool enough now so that it
-will keep until we get over the range." Before long the packs were
-lashed, and all the members of the party were in the saddle and
-pushing their way up the stream.
-
-There was now no visible trail. The snow covered everything, and
-though it was dripping fast from the trees at their level, they
-could see that on the higher hills it still hung thick upon the
-branches. From time to time the stream narrowed, so that they were
-obliged to leave it and climb the ridges, which often afforded much
-better going than the creek bottom. As they climbed higher and
-higher, everything was draped in white; but now the sun went behind
-the clouds, and the glare of the white snow was not uncomfortable.
-Hugh had said as they started, "You boys better take and blacken
-your faces; I am going to do it;" and taking some charcoal from the
-fire, each of the party rubbed the black over the upper parts of
-the face, the cheeks, the bridge of the nose, and around the eyes,
-to keep the glare from the snow from affecting the eyes.
-
-They climbed higher and higher, and as they climbed, the stream
-grew smaller. From time to time they reached some point from
-which there was an extended view, showing far-reaching, snow-clad
-mountains and evergreen forests; and ahead of them the high peaks
-of the main divide, with precipices of bare black rock, to which
-the snow could not cling. As they passed along, Jack noticed
-frequent tracks of deer and elk, and others of smaller animals
-which he did not recognize, and which there was no time to stop
-and ask about. Hugh rode fast, and the boys kept the animals close
-behind him. Often for a little distance through an open valley, or
-along a bare ridge, Hugh would trot or gallop. He was evidently
-anxious to get on.
-
-It was growing dark when, at the head of a pretty, open valley,
-Hugh turned his horse into the timber, and after looking around for
-a moment, said, "We'll camp here, boys. Bring the horses right up
-close to Baldy." They did so, and soon had the loads on the ground.
-Poles were quickly cut, the lodge was put up, and the ground within
-it was soon cleared of snow, and a fire started. Then, under Hugh's
-direction, the boys went out and broke several armfuls of spruce
-boughs, which they brought in and placed around the walls of the
-lodge where the beds would be spread, to keep them off the snow.
-Two of the horses had already been picketed and the others hobbled.
-There was danger that night they might desert, and take the back
-trail for the lower ground, where, of course, they well remembered
-that there was good grass, while up here to get anything to eat
-they would have to paw through the deep snow.
-
-"You boys had better cook supper," said Hugh. "I'm going down to
-the end of this valley, to see if I can't stop it up in some way so
-that the horses can't get away to-night; they're likely to leave
-us, and if they do, we'll have to hunt them to-morrow."
-
-Before entering this valley they had passed up through a narrow
-cañon, riding for a short distance in the stream-bed, and Hugh, who
-had noticed two or three spruce trees standing on either side of
-the stream, took an axe, went down there, and felling two of the
-trees across the stream, made a fence that the horses could not
-surmount. They could possibly get around by climbing high on the
-hillside, but as all the loose ones were hobbled, it was not likely
-that they would go very far up hill.
-
-When he returned to the camp supper was ready, and before long they
-were all fast asleep.
-
-The next morning was bright and cold. No more snow had fallen.
-The horses were all there, but those that had been hobbled looked
-gaunt and hungry. Hugh was up before daylight and took off their
-hobbles, and when the sun rose they were all busily at work getting
-what must have been their supper and breakfast. When their front
-feet were tied together, they could not paw through the snow to the
-grass beneath.
-
-"Now boys," said Hugh, as soon as breakfast was over, "let's saddle
-up and get along. I'd like mightily to get over the range to-day,
-if we can." It took but a short time to get started, for the three
-had now been working together so long that they wasted no time, and
-made no unnecessary motions.
-
-Neither of the boys had noticed the night before how deep the snow
-was; but to-day they could see that down here under the trees it
-was eight or ten inches deep, though perhaps in the open where it
-had a chance to melt or to blow off there was not so much.
-
-As they went forward, Jack was more and more interested in the
-tracks. Down at the foot of a cañon wall in the valley he saw a
-series of tiny parallel dots in the snow, which he thought must
-have been made by a little striped squirrel, which had run out
-from the broken rock-fragments where he had his home, down nearly
-to the water's edge, and then, frightened by some sight or sound,
-had turned and hurried, with long bounds, back to his rocky home.
-Higher up on the hill, about every weed-stalk that showed above the
-surface of the snow were numbers of long parallel depressions, and
-scattered about on the snow were fragments of the seed-cases of the
-plants, and strips of the bark of the stem. Here the birds had been
-at work, and so hard pressed for food that they had visited almost
-every projecting plant.
-
-There had been killing during the night; death had been abroad,
-travelling over the barren hills, and pushing his way among the
-thickly clustered pines. There had been battles and ambuscades, and
-stern unrelenting pursuits; fierce struggles; resistance, feeble
-and unavailing; despair, and, at last, yielding, when the hope of
-escape was lost. More than one life had gone out that night on the
-hillside. Here, close to the margin of a little brook, was a pile
-of bright blue feathers, telling its story of death, and near it
-in the light snow, long, light strokes, which told of some fierce
-bird, that, in the gray light of the morning, had crushed in his
-strong crooked talons a little blue-bird which was just beginning
-his journey toward the south. There were tracks of a fox winding
-about on the hillside, often quartering the ground like a well
-trained hunting dog. He had covered much ground, and had visited
-every spot that might give shelter to his prey. In one place Jack
-saw the tracks of a grouse, and those of a fox following them, then
-suddenly the tracks of the grouse were seen no more, the last two
-sunk deep in the snow, showing where the bird had sprung from the
-ground and had darted away among the snow-laden trees. A few feet
-from these, Jack could see where the fox had stopped when the bird
-took flight, and he could fancy how angrily the sly fellow gazed
-after it as he saw his wished-for breakfast disappear. A little
-further on the fox had been more lucky, and a hole dug in the snow
-and a tuft or two of bluish fur showed where the keen-nosed hunter
-had caught a mouse.
-
-At the border of a grove of pines, Jack saw the impress of the
-great pads of the snowshoe rabbit, scarcely sinking into the
-light snow. For the most part, the rabbits kept close under the
-evergreens where the snow was less deep, and food most easily to
-be found; but if startled by fox or wolf, they could readily run
-over the drifts, where the heavier pursuer must sink into them, far
-behind.
-
-As they climbed higher and higher, the trees grew larger, and
-now they began to see, through the valley and coming down from
-the higher hills on either side, the tracks of elk. The heavy
-snow-fall, warning these animals of the near approach of winter,
-had set them in motion down from the peaks, and everywhere trails
-were seen leading from the hillside into the valley. They saw none
-of the animals, for the footfalls of the pack-train clambering over
-the rocks, the sound of dead branches rattling against the packs,
-and the calls to the horses alarmed the elk at a distance, and they
-retreated to the timber, out of sight.
-
-Presently the climbing seemed at an end for the present, and the
-valley became more open and nearly level. Not far ahead off to the
-southeast they could see a low pass in the mountains, which seemed
-likely to be the one they were trying to find. As they ascended,
-the stream continued to grow smaller, large branches, almost equal
-in size to the main brook kept coming into it, and often it was
-uncertain which was the main fork. Hugh gave no hint of what was
-passing in his mind, but pushed on, and the boys kept the animals
-close behind him.
-
-In this broad level valley there were more elk tracks than ever.
-These, seen at a distance, were very pretty, often looking like two
-delicate chains laid side by side, and running for a long distance
-almost in a straight line. Sometimes the animals seemed to have
-wandered about, biting off the heads of the grass and weeds that
-stood above the snow; but always at last the tracks turned and kept
-on down the valley. In the middle of the great meadow stood an
-old pine stub, and a number of the tracks converged to this, and
-then went away from it in one path. It seemed that the elk, coming
-along, had gone to this stump, and rubbed against it, and then all
-followed the same trail going away.
-
-As the afternoon advanced, the valley grew narrow again and they
-entered the timber, and soon afterward came on what was evidently
-a trail that had been travelled both by whites and Indians. Some
-of the trees were blazed with an axe, but many years ago, for the
-bark had partly grown over the old blazes; there were later marks
-where little three-cornered patches of the bark had been knocked
-off, showing where the hard corners of packs had struck against
-the trees. On one or two of the trees were seen little woolen
-threads, white and red, showing where some Indian's blanket had
-rubbed against the trunk and left a little sign, to remain there
-for years. At length, the trail again passed out of the timber into
-a narrow valley, and a sharp climb brought them to a place where
-water seemed to be flowing down hill both before and behind them.
-Hugh stopped and waved his hand and pointed ahead; and beyond they
-could see a valley, steep-walled and full of timber, stretching off
-toward the southeast.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XII
-
-WHAT WILL BECOME OF THE ELK?
-
-
-"Here we are, boys; this is the divide--the top of the range,"
-said Hugh. "Now if we can only get down this hill and find decent
-travelling in the valley, we'll soon be out of this snow. I expect
-this is one of the heads of Wind River, and I hope we can make it
-down below the snow to-morrow."
-
-The way down the new stream was steep, and for a while progress
-was slow. There appeared to be no trail, and several times Hugh
-dismounted and went ahead slowly on foot, to pick out a way for the
-animals down steep rock slides. At last, however, they came to a
-point where the stream had a little bottom, thickly overgrown with
-timber, but all of it green; and working their way along through
-this they came, shortly before sundown, to a little open park
-surrounded by willows, where they camped.
-
-There was a little daylight left after camp had been made and
-supper eaten, and Jack, with Hugh, walked out to the edge of the
-stream. There was a good deal of water flowing in it, for ever
-since they came into the valley they had been crossing rivulets
-and brooklets, tumbling down from the high hills and pouring
-their current into the valley. The little river flowed among the
-close-set pines, and its bed was composed of great blocks of
-stone. Just opposite the camp it opened out into a pool twenty
-feet long, and half as wide; and, as they stood here, they saw two
-little dippers at work in the stream.
-
-Although Jack had often seen these birds in the northern mountains,
-they constantly interested him. He knew that, although living
-always in and about the water, their nearest relations were not
-water-birds, such as ducks or snipe, but instead were thrushes,
-of which the common robin is one. Yet as many times as he had
-seen them diving into the water, swimming about on it, and again
-disappearing beneath its waves, he could never quite get over his
-astonishment at seeing a bird walk down the shelving rock or smooth
-beach into the water, and keep on walking, without attempting to
-swim or to dive, until it had disappeared.
-
-He spoke about this now to Hugh, and said, "Those are the queerest
-little birds I ever saw, and I don't know of any like them
-anywhere."
-
-"Yes," said Hugh, "they are queer; but they're mighty
-cheerful--mighty good company if you're alone in the mountains.
-They stay here, you know, all summer and all winter, wherever the
-water is open, and they've got a real nice little song, and they
-sing, too, at all seasons of the year. There, listen to that one,"
-he said, as a dipper appeared from under the water in the pool
-before them, and then flying to an old dead stick that projected
-from the bank, alighted on it and began to warble a simple but
-pleasing song. After it had finished, it flew part way across the
-pool, and then dived from the wing, and came to the surface again
-some distance below where it had entered the water. Then flying to
-a rock it seemed to batter to pieces some small object which it had
-brought up from the bottom, which it then devoured.
-
-"Don't it seem queer, Hugh," said Jack, "that they never get wet;
-their plumage seems light and fluffy, like that of a land bird, and
-not close and compact like that of the duck or grebe. They must
-have a big oil-sack, and must oil up their feathers pretty often."
-
-"I reckon they do," said Hugh, "but I'm sure they never get wet.
-I've often wondered what it is they feed on; I suppose it's insects
-that live at the bottom of the water. Anyhow, I've often seen them
-bring up one of those little worms that build sort of houses for
-themselves out of sticks and little bits of sand, and take it to a
-rock and pound it to pieces, and then eat the worm that's inside of
-it. You've seen those things, haven't you? I don't know what they
-do, or what they're good for, without it is to feed the birds and
-the fish."
-
-"Oh yes, Hugh," said Jack, "I've often seen those. Mighty queer
-little houses they are, but I don't know any more than you do
-what the insect in them lives for. I expect he may turn into a
-dragonfly, or maybe some kind of beetle or other. I know I've
-heard that there are lots of insects that lay their eggs, and live
-part of their lives in water, and then finally, coming up to the
-surface, change their shape and become perfect insects."
-
-"Well," said Hugh, "I expect likely that's the way it may be."
-
-Jack noticed that the dippers seemed to dive into the upper part of
-the pool, and to be carried down by the swift current close to a
-little point of rocks, and slowly walking out there, and standing
-perfectly still, he soon saw one of the birds drop down from a
-large stone near him, and disappear under the water. He could see a
-sort of a flying shadow under the surface, and in a moment the bird
-came up a little below him, and flew off to the other side of the
-stream. As it grew darker, the dippers disappeared, having probably
-gone to their roost; and as the two returned to camp, Hugh said to
-Jack, "Son, did you ever see one of the nests made by these birds?"
-
-"No, Hugh, I never did," said Jack.
-
-"Well, we must be on the lookout for that. They're mighty queer
-little nests. On the outside they seem to be made of green moss, so
-that the nests look just like a bunch of moss growing on a rock.
-Often they build them close under some little water-fall, and I
-expect maybe it's the mist from the fall that keeps the moss wet
-and growing; but if the outside is damp and wet, the inside is just
-as dry as can be, and the young birds have a good warm place, and a
-good roof over their heads. It's kind of fun to watch one of these
-nests and see how hard the old birds have to work to keep the young
-birds quiet. They come with an insect, and give it to some one of
-the young ones, and then dart off, and are not gone more than a
-few minutes, and then come back again, so both the old birds keep
-travelling back and forth; and all the time the young ones are
-making all the noise they can, only you can't hear'em for the sound
-of the water--they're a hungry lot, I tell you. Of course, the
-breeding season is past a long time now, and maybe if we keep our
-eyes open we'll be able to see a nest and get it for you to take
-home with you, though often they're in a place where it's mighty
-hard to get at them."
-
-The little circular meadow in which they had camped was not large
-enough to give good feeding for their horses, even if the ground
-had not been covered with snow; but Hugh felt certain that the
-horses would not try to follow the back trail up the hill again,
-nor did he think that they would venture away down the stream
-into country unknown to them. However, he picketed two horses and
-hobbled most of the others, and when morning came they were most of
-them in sight, though one or two had strayed away into the timber.
-The snow on the ground made it an easy matter to follow them, and
-soon after sunrise the train had started on again.
-
-The travelling was better than had been expected. Although
-sometimes the walls of the valley drew so close together that there
-was hardly room for the stream to flow, they managed to get along
-without very much climbing, and were all the time going down hill.
-The next night when they camped, the snow had almost entirely
-disappeared from the valley, only patches lying in some of the most
-shady spots. There was abundant sign of game here, but they saw
-none, nor did they look for it. The next afternoon however, Hugh
-stopped as they were crossing a meadow, and, calling Jack to him,
-pointed out some tracks in the soft ground, which Jack at first
-supposed were elk tracks, but on more careful examination found to
-be quite different; and after thinking for a moment, he asked Hugh
-if they could be moose tracks.
-
-"Yes," said Hugh, "that's just what they are. This was a good bull,
-and he crossed here early this morning. Follow his tracks a little
-way and see if you can make out anything special about them, and
-then come on after us and tell me what you saw."
-
-Jack followed slowly along on the tracks until they entered the
-timber. Then he returned to take his position in the pack train.
-By this time the way was so open that it was not necessary to
-travel in single file, and Jack, riding up to Hugh said, "Well,
-Hugh, those tracks are about twice as long as an elk's track, and
-only a little bit wider; that makes them look long and narrow.
-Then, besides that, I noticed that whenever the animal went over a
-soft spot, and his foot sank in a little, there seemed to be two
-marks behind the main track, and I suppose those are the dew claws
-sinking in. Is that so?"
-
-"That's it," said Hugh, "I'm glad you took notice so carefully.
-Maybe we'll get a chance to kill a moose before we get down out of
-these mountains. We don't really want one now; but you've never
-seen a moose, and I expect if one should show up, why maybe you'd
-want to shoot at it."
-
-"Well, Hugh, I guess I would," said Jack; "but I suppose as long
-as we're travelling here with the pack train, and making so much
-noise, there isn't much chance of our seeing one."
-
-"No, not much," said Hugh.
-
-As the valley became wider, and the stream larger, there seemed
-to be more life in the bottom. Several broods of ruffed grouse
-had been noticed during the day, and all were so tame that they
-scarcely moved out of the horses' way as they passed along. In
-the river there were a few ducks, of the kind that breed high up
-in the mountains; and the next morning, when Jack was down at the
-water's edge, just after he had risen, he saw a hawk make a dash at
-a family of ducks. The ducks were flying down the river when the
-hawk came out of the timber and darted toward them. They all fell
-into the water, with loud splashings, and the hawk swooped at one
-of them which was a little apart from the main flock; but the duck
-made a rush to one side and easily avoided it. Then the hawk gave
-up the chase, and flew into a tall tree, where he watched the ducks
-as they swam swiftly down the stream. Jack was amused at a little
-spotted sandpiper that had been flying up the stream when the hawk
-darted for the ducks. The bird was very much frightened, thinking
-that the hawk was after it. It dropped into the water as if it had
-been shot, and sat there with its head cocked to one side, watching
-the enemy, and prepared to dive at a second's warning, if the hawk
-should dash at it.
-
-The weather was bright and pleasant, and they kept on down the
-stream, which constantly grew wider. Now there was some sage-brush
-on the benches above the bottom, and often the trail kept away from
-the stream, and close under these benches, in order to avoid the
-frequent wet and miry places which would have troubled the horses.
-As Jack was riding along he suddenly heard a shot behind him, and
-looking about, saw three deer running near the top of a ridge,
-and just below the timber. Joe had shot at one of them, and just
-after Jack looked round, two of them disappeared over the ridge.
-The last one stopped almost at its crest, and looked back, and Joe
-fired again. The doe fell, and Joe rode up to where she lay. The
-train was halted, and when the deer had been brought down to the
-trail she was put on one of the packs and they started on again. As
-the bottom became wider it was evident that beaver had been much at
-work here, and although they had long deserted it, the marshes and
-sloughs and mud-holes caused by their damming of the stream still
-remained as pitfalls for the traveller.
-
-Ever since they had left Snake River they had heard from time to
-time the shrill bugling call of the elk, though near the top of the
-range where the snow was deepest they had not heard them whistle.
-Now, however, they frequently heard elk, and on this day an old
-bull came out of a point of timber near which they were travelling,
-and stood and looked at them. He was but a short distance off,
-and might easily have been killed; but they had meat enough, and
-there was no reason for shooting him. He was but forty or fifty
-yards distant, and seemed disposed to come even nearer, making
-some threatening demonstrations with his head, and advancing a few
-steps; but no attention was paid to him, and presently he turned
-about and disappeared in the timber. Hugh said that very likely the
-elk took some of the pack animals for cows, and wished to gather
-them in.
-
-That night they camped on an enlargement of the river, which almost
-seemed like a little lake. Behind them and on either side were
-timbered hills, before them the water, and beyond the mountains
-rising steeply. The lodge stood in a little grove of pine trees,
-which furnished shelter and fuel, and the hungry animals fed on the
-rich grass behind it. The bright fire in front of the lodge lit up
-the trees and the lodge and the pack saddles, and as it flamed and
-flickered, curious shadows peeped out from the dark caverns that
-stretched back beneath the pine branches to the gloom beyond, and
-sometimes creeping stealthily forth, danced for a moment within the
-circle of the firelight, and then chased one another back into the
-darkness, and were swallowed up in it. The soft murmur of the river
-over its stones came to the campers in a monotonous undertone,
-while now and then from the nearby trees came the plaintive call of
-some bird, and the mountain sides echoed at intervals to the fierce
-shrill challenge of the angry elk.
-
-"This is a great elk country, isn't it, Hugh?" said Jack. "It seems
-to me that elk are 'most everywhere, and I suppose they'll always
-be here, won't they?"
-
-"Well, I don't know, son," said Hugh; "it's pretty hard to say
-about that. They'll likely be here until the white folks come;
-but as soon as they come, why the elk are bound to go. I've heard
-they're talking about passing a law not to let them be killed in
-the Park we came through--that place where the hot springs and
-spouting fountains are. But just as soon as mineral is discovered
-in these hills, the game will go. I reckon, too, that this law
-they're talking about passing for that Park back there won't amount
-to much, for I talked with two hunters there who said that they
-expected to get the contract this winter to kill meat for all them
-fellows that's working on those buildings that we saw. Of course
-what two men'll kill in a winter won't amount to much; but just
-as soon as many people begin to come into this country, the game
-will all get killed off. I've seen places down in the south, in
-Colorado, where twenty or twenty-five years ago game was so plenty
-that you could kill all you wanted right close to camp, any time;
-and now that country is full of settlers, miners and ranchmen, and
-they've killed off the game for the mining camps and tie camps and
-every settler has to go and get three or four wagon loads for his
-winter's meat, and the first thing they know there won't be a hoof
-left in the country."
-
-"Well, but Hugh," said Jack, "what's going to become of all the
-game? Isn't there going to be any left after a few years?"
-
-"You can't prove it by me, son. I don't know; but I expect there
-won't be any game left, unless they pass some laws, and enforce
-them, to stop the killing of it. Of course laws don't mean anything
-without they're enforced, and as far as I can see, these laws
-protecting the game never are enforced."
-
-"But, Hugh," said Jack, "that seems to me all wrong. Do you mean to
-say that if I come out here twenty years from now there won't be
-anything for me to hunt?"
-
-"Looks that way to me, son," said Hugh.
-
-"And if I should have a son, and ever want to bring him out here
-and show him the things that I saw when I was a boy, he could not
-see them?"
-
-"I don't believe he could. I tell you, son, this country has
-changed an awful lot since I first saw it, and it seems to me it's
-changing more and more all the time, and quicker now than it used
-to. I used to think that the time would never come when I couldn't
-go out and kill meat if I wanted it; but my ideas have changed a
-whole lot in the last year or two, and I believe now that the time
-will come when there won't be any game left for a man to shoot with
-a rifle. I used to think that the buffalo could never be killed
-off, but I've seen 'em killed off over part of the country, and I
-may live long enough to see 'em killed off everywhere."
-
-"Well," said Jack, "it seems as if there ought to be some way to
-stop that."
-
-"Yes, there ought to be," said Hugh, "but you see, every fellow
-that comes out into the mountains, he's just like you and me; we
-think the other fellow oughtn't to kill game, but we ought to kill
-it. We claim that we don't kill anything more than what we want
-to eat, and these other fellows claim, maybe--if they're buffalo
-skinners or elk skinners--that they don't kill any more than they
-want to skin. Each man thinks that what he'll kill won't do any
-harm; but when they're all at work killing as hard as they can, the
-upshot of it is that there's no game left."
-
-"I see," said Jack; "each one of us is thinking about himself and
-about nobody else, and yet each one of us is likely to talk about
-what the other people do. You must have seen lots of game in your
-life, Hugh," he added.
-
-"Yes, son," said Hugh, "I've seen a heap of game. Why, at one time
-men used to travel day after day, and never be out of sight of
-game; and most times the game was not afraid at all. Buffalo or elk
-or antelope would just move out the way, and a man never thought
-of shooting at anything until he needed meat to eat. Of course in
-those times we never took anything but the best parts, and so it
-often happened that we killed an animal every two or three days.
-But we never thought, up to within a very few years ago, when
-railroads began to come into the country, that things would be much
-different from what they were then; but when the railroads came,
-they brought a heap of people, a good many of them hunters, and a
-good many of them men who came to live on the land where the game
-had always roamed without being bothered by anybody, except maybe
-once a year when Indians happened to pass that way and perhaps
-camped in the neighborhood for a few weeks. Of course the time has
-been when a man could easily enough kill a car-load of game in a
-day, but in the old times no one had any reason for doing that. We
-could only eat about so much meat, and wear about so much buckskin;
-and ammunition cost money, and nobody wanted to waste it."
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XIII
-
-A PACK HORSE IN DANGER
-
-
-They had not gone far down the river the next morning when the
-mountains on either side drew closer together, and the valley
-narrowed greatly. Before they had gone far Hugh stopped, and,
-turning, said to the boys as they came up, "I don't like the looks
-of things ahead; I reckon we'll have to go up on the hillside down
-below here. Looks to me like we were coming to a cañon."
-
-A little farther along it proved so; and Hugh, after going ahead
-and making a little investigation, called out to the boys to bring
-on the animals. They found him on a narrow game trail, which began
-to climb the hill among thick timber, where the trees stood so
-close on both sides of the trail that it was evident that there
-might be trouble in getting the packs along. Hugh got an axe out
-of the pack, and, going ahead on foot, began to chop the branches
-on either side, so as to make room for the loaded horses. Two or
-three times he found small trees fallen across the trail, and, as
-it was extremely steep, it was necessary to cut out each one of
-these. Progress was slow, but after two or three hours they emerged
-from the timber and could see ahead of them the trail leading
-along a very steep hillside. Immediately below the trail grew
-underbrush, and below that the rocks fell off sharply to the river.
-From the hillside a number of little brooks and springs trickled
-down, making slippery, muddy places in the trail over which it
-was necessary to go carefully. Hugh several times called back to
-the boys, saying, "Go slow along this place, and don't crowd the
-animals; let each one take its time, and you boys go on foot. The
-horses will follow all right."
-
-There was nothing on the trail that was difficult for a man on foot
-or for a careful horse, and for some time they went on very well,
-and made good time; but in crossing a little brook which ran down
-over the trail, and where there was a mud-hole, the bay horse,
-pausing and putting down his head to investigate the trail, was
-crowded upon by the dun and kicked back at him with both heels,
-and when his feet came down they were over the edge of the trail,
-and, trying to recover himself, he clumsily fell down and rolled
-over once or twice. Just below the trail at this point there was
-a big patch of stiff alders growing close to the steep hillside.
-Jack saw the horse begin to fall, and, dropping his own bridle rein
-and placing his gun on the hillside above the trail, he slipped by
-the dun, and before the pack horse had turned over twice he had
-caught it by its hackamore and checked it. In a moment Joe was by
-his side, and the two hung on like grim death, and held the horse
-there on its side, with its head a little up the hill. Meantime
-Hugh had left his horse and come back along the trail, and in a
-moment he too had hold of the horse's head. Fortunately, the horse
-lay perfectly quiet, and neither slid nor rolled, his hips being
-more or less supported by the alders. Hugh quickly unfastened the
-hackamore, which gave all hands a better hold, and then said to
-Jack, "Slip down there now, behind the horse, and see if you can
-loosen that lash rope. If you can't, cut the lacing that holds it
-to the cinch. We've got to get that pack off, or else lose the
-animal. Don't get where the horse can hit you with his feet; reach
-over his back."
-
-The horse was lying on its off side, and it was impossible to
-loosen the lash rope, but reaching over the back, Jack cut the
-lacings of the lash cinch, so that the whole lash rope fell off.
-"Now," said Hugh, "come back here and hang on to the hackamore."
-Jack took Hugh's place, and Hugh quickly loosened the sling ropes,
-and removing the packs from the saddle, carried them up to the
-trail, and then along it a little distance until he reached a place
-where the ground on the upper side sloped more gradually. Here he
-deposited the packs one by one; then he took hold of the hackamore
-again and said to Jack, "Go and get your rope and bring it here,
-and tie it round this horse's neck in a bowline." When this had
-been done, the end of the rope was passed round a small spruce
-tree, which grew just above the trail, and then all three held the
-rope, so that now the horse could not possibly roll down the hill,
-unless the tree gave way, or the men let the rope go. While two of
-them held the rope, Jack led the horses along the trail, until a
-place was reached where it came out on a wider ledge, and leaving
-them there returned. Then the pack horse was made to rise to its
-feet, and without very great difficulty, assisted by the rope about
-its neck, it climbed back to the trail and was led along to a place
-where there was more room. Now, while Hugh mended the lash cinch,
-the boys carried the packs along the trail to where it was wider,
-and at length the horse was re-packed, and they started on.
-
-While they were at work, Jack said to Hugh, "I want you to
-understand, Hugh, that I didn't drive the dun onto that horse. The
-dun came up behind him and stopped, and the bay kicked at him, and
-lost his footing, and went over the side of the trail."
-
-"I know," said Hugh, "I know; I was watching. It wasn't anybody's
-fault, but the fool horse that tried to kill himself. You did
-mighty well to get hold of him as quick as you did, and if it
-hadn't been for that, if he'd made one more roll, he'd have gone
-over the rocks, and we'd have lost him, and likely a lot of the
-load he's carrying.
-
-"We've got to look for things like this when we're travelling with
-a pack train, and I'm mighty surprised that we've had as little
-trouble as we have."
-
-It was near sundown when Hugh stopped as they came out on a bench
-of the hillside, and said: "I reckon we'll have to camp up here
-to-night, boys. There don't seem to be any place where we can get
-down to the river. There's good grass here for the horses and a
-place where we can picket two or three of them, but I don't see any
-water just here. Jack, you ride up the hill, and see whether you
-can find anything that looks like a spring. Joe and I'll stop here
-with the horses."
-
-Jack had not ridden far, when, passing over a little ridge, he
-found, issuing from a ledge of rock, a good spring, which ran down
-into a little ravine, and calling to the others, they came up
-there, unsaddled, and made camp. It was dark when supper was over,
-and their talk was chiefly of the difficulties of the day, and the
-narrow escape had by the pack horse.
-
-"A man is bound to lose an animal in the mountains now and then,"
-said Hugh, "not always through his own carelessness, but because
-there's always some horses and mules that are fools. After all a
-horse is nothing but a bundle of nerves, and if he gets scared and
-loses his head, why he doesn't do anything but jump round and kick
-and make things worse for himself. Now, that's where a good man
-has the bulge on any dumb beast that ever was. A man, if he's got
-sense, will stop and think, and reason, and try to find some way
-out of his difficulty; but a critter doesn't do that. That's the
-reason horses and mules and cattle stampede, and that's the reason
-often that human beings stampede too; they lose their senses, and
-become no better at all than just so many animals. We've always
-got to keep our wits about us, be ready, and when anything happens
-do the right thing, and do it right off--like you did to-day, son,
-when you ran to grab that horse's head, and like you did too, Joe;
-for I saw that you were both ready. You saved us the horse, and a
-mighty good job it is.
-
-"I remember one day, years ago, we lost our whole kitchen outfit
-just through the foolishness of a mule. It was near Henry's Fork of
-Green River, and I was guiding a lot of soldiers and bug hunters
-up from the Unita agency. To get down into the valley we had to
-follow down a mighty sharp crest that ran out between two deep
-ravines. It was mighty narrow, and a terrible long way down on
-either side, but there were no bad places in it; but a big bay mule
-that carried the kitchen, in two big baskets, tried to turn round
-and look at the rest of the train that were coming, and somehow
-she caught her hind legs over the edge, and they slipped down,
-and she hung a little while with her forefeet, but before any one
-could get to her she let go, and she fell. She was dead long before
-she struck the bottom, I guess, and the kitchen was all smashed
-and broken up. I believe we did get some knives and forks and tin
-plates out of the mess, but the plates were all battered, and had
-to be hammered out on a tree with an axe before they would set on
-the ground. It was one of the worst falls I ever saw an animal
-take."
-
-The next morning the horses were seen scattered all along the
-hillside above the camp, and it took the boys some time to gather
-and bring them in; and while they were doing this, a big doe,
-followed by two little fawns, jumped up out of a patch of quaking
-aspen, ran a short distance up above them on the hillside, and then
-all three animals turning round stood looking at them, with their
-great ears thrown forward. The boys stood for a few moments and
-looked at her, and then she turned again and clambered still higher
-up, only to stop again for another look. Neither felt any desire to
-shoot at her.
-
-The greater part of the day was devoted to working down stream
-along the hillside. They found that they could travel with some
-comfort on the benches, except when these were interrupted at
-frequent intervals by deep ravines, cut out by streams coming down
-from the hills, and the plunge down into these, and the subsequent
-climb up the other side, was tiring to the animals. Also they had
-to stop frequently to adjust the packs and tighten the saddles.
-
-That night they camped again on the benches, and Hugh said, "I
-believe we'll do as well to stop somewhere, if we can find a good
-camp, and rest up for two or three days. These horses have been
-having hard work now for some little time, and they'll get poor.
-Besides that, this up and down work is awful hard on their backs,
-and I think it would be a good idea to given 'em a rest. If we
-can find a good camp to-morrow, any time in the day, as we're
-travelling along, I think we better stop and rest up, or we can
-stop right here. You boys might want to take a hunt or a fish. It's
-nice weather now, and we're low enough down so that there's no
-danger that the snow will catch us, and I think we can spare the
-time."
-
-"Well, Hugh," said Jack, "I think that's a pretty good idea. I'd
-like to look over these hills and see what there is in them, and I
-guess we'd all like to rest for a day."
-
-The next few days were spent in this camp. Hugh was busy mending up
-saddles and riggings, fixing blankets, and getting things in good
-shape for their further journey, while Jack fished a good deal in
-the river and took many trout.
-
-One day while working around the edge of a large pool, and trying
-to cover it all with his line, he found himself close to a steep
-rocky wall, over which poured a fall six or eight feet high. He had
-fished here for some minutes, when suddenly his eye caught a round
-brownish-green bunch of something, resting on a little ledge close
-to the falls and over deep water; and as he saw it he thought that
-this must be a nest of the dipper. It was impossible to get close
-to it, and remembering that it was now autumn and that the nest by
-no possibility could contain anything, he reached over with his
-pole, and pushing it from its position, it fell to the water and
-was soon in his hand. He found it just what Hugh had described: a
-bunch of moss, containing a chamber within, lined with dried grass
-and a few feathers, and with a round hole at the front for the
-passage in and out of the birds. It was a beautiful piece of bird
-architecture, and he determined to take it with him and to try to
-carry it back east.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XIV
-
-A BIGHORN
-
-
-While Hugh had been working and Jack fishing, Joe had been roaming
-the hillsides. He had found some signs of game and killed another
-little fawn, but had not been higher up than the first bench above
-the camp. From there, however, he had seen higher mountains rising
-beyond, and one night he said to Jack, "Jack, why don't you quit
-catching these fish, and let's go up high on the hills here, and
-see if we can't kill something?"
-
-"That's a good idea, Joe," said Hugh, "the meat of these
-black-tails is about gone now, and it's a good idea for you boys
-to go out and kill something more. That last fawn that you got is
-almost gone, too. We don't want to keep eating fish all the rest of
-the trip.
-
-"Good enough," said Jack. "I'll go you; and we'll start early
-to-morrow morning. Shall we take horses, Hugh?"
-
-"Why, no," said Hugh, "if I were you I'd leave the horses here to
-rest, and go afoot. You can hunt better afoot, and then if you kill
-anything that's too big for you to pack in, you can come down and
-get a horse for it."
-
-The next morning the two boys started early, and for a long time
-scrambled up the hill. When they reached the top of the bench
-above camp, they found before them a plateau, more or less level,
-and beyond that rose another ridge, which cut off the view. They
-climbed and climbed for a long time, passing over one bench after
-another, and at length, a little before noon, Joe saw far off
-on the hillside, at about the same level with themselves, three
-mountain sheep. They were on quite another mountain, for there were
-two wide gorges between them and the boys; and, what was more to
-the point, the sheep had already seen them and were looking. So the
-boys kept on climbing.
-
-At last they reached the rocks, a great brown slope of broken
-weathered lichen-covered stones, which rose steeply before them;
-but the going was not bad, and they climbed up, heading always for
-a place where the precipices above seemed broken away, so that they
-could get through. It was now noon and the sun shone warm, but a
-cool breeze was blowing along the hillside, and the air was fresh
-and invigorating. Jack said, "Now, Joe, when we get to the top of
-this cliff we'll find a sheltered place, and sit down there and
-eat."
-
-"That will be good," said Joe; "I'm hungry." They had now climbed
-quite high, and looking across at the mountain on the other side of
-the stream, could see that the timber was small, and that a little
-higher up it seemed to stop. Joe said, "We ought to see sheep up
-here, it seems to me."
-
-"I should think so," said Jack, "but we'll have to wait until
-we get to some place where we can get a good look along the
-mountain." Before long they reached a ravine, and clambering up it
-for some distance came out on a rocky hillside, from which both
-to the north and south they could see a long way over ground that
-for the most part was open and steeply sloping. Above them the
-mountains rose in a series of narrow benches--a bench not more than
-fifty feet wide, and then a cliff as high, then another bench,
-and another cliff, and so on up. Here, choosing a place which was
-sheltered from the wind, they sat down and rested for a while, at
-the same time eating their bread and dried meat, which tasted very
-good. When they had finished, Jack said:
-
-"Now, Joe, you know more about the mountains than I do. What shall
-we do? Shall we keep on climbing, and try to get up to the top, or
-shall we walk along one of these benches? I suppose if we do that
-we might easily enough run across some sheep, for at this time of
-the day they'd be likely to be lying down in just such places."
-
-"Yes," said Joe, "that's so; but if they're lying down there,
-they're looking 'round all the time, and pretty sure to see you
-before you see them. Then maybe they'll make one jump out of sight,
-going up the hill, or down, and you don't get a shot."
-
-"Well, then," said Jack, "let's go higher."
-
-"All right," said Joe, "we'll go ahead."
-
-The climb was steep and rough and hard, but they kept at it for
-sometime longer, and at last found themselves up above the benches
-and on a gentle rounded rock slope, where little grass grew. There
-were no trees or tall weeds.
-
- [Illustration: "ALMOST BELOW THEM, FEEDING, WERE TWO GOOD SIZED
- RAMS."--_Page 183_]
-
-"Now," said Joe, "I think we've got to the place. Now we can work
-along and look down into these ravines, or little basins, or onto
-the ledges, and maybe if we see sheep we'll be above them and can
-get to them."
-
-They followed the ridge down the stream, and in the first ravine
-that they came to they saw a big drift of snow. They headed that,
-and as they went on, found that in all the low places on the
-mountain top there was more or less snow. They had gone more than
-half a mile when, peering over a crest of rock, they looked down
-into a pretty little basin in which there was a good deal of snow,
-but above the snow grew green grass, and almost below them feeding
-were two good sized rams. The animals did not see them, and they
-drew back.
-
-"Now, Joe," said Jack, "which of us shall shoot? I guess you'd
-better, because I don't think you have ever killed a big ram, have
-you?"
-
-"No," said Joe, "I never killed a ram as big as this, but then I've
-killed sheep, and I'll have plenty of chances to hunt when maybe
-you won't. You'd better shoot."
-
-"No," said Jack, "I'd rather have you."
-
-"No," said Joe, "you shoot."
-
-"Well, I tell you," said Jack, "let's toss up for it, the way we
-did before," and picking up a small flat stone he spat on one side
-of it, and said, "we'll call the wet side heads. Now, you call,"
-and throwing it up in the air, Joe called "Head" and "tail" came
-uppermost.
-
-"All right," said Jack, "that settles it." He stepped forward and
-shot, and Joe stood beside him, ready, in case Jack should miss.
-At the crack of the gun the two sheep jumped a little, but did not
-run away but stood looking in all directions. Jack said to Joe,
-"Now you give him another," and Joe fired at the sheep Jack had
-shot at. Almost as the gun cracked, the sheep sank to his knees,
-and its head fell down. The boys reloaded their guns, and began
-to pick their way down the rocks to it. The other ram stood until
-they had approached quite near to it, and then suddenly seeming to
-become very much frightened, rushed away along the mountain side,
-and was soon seen climbing the cliff.
-
-They could see that the ram that had fallen was big and fat, and
-knew that they could not take the whole of the meat into camp with
-them, and both felt quite sure that they could not bring an animal
-up here. At least, if they could do so, it would take all day to
-do it. On turning over the sheep and examining it, they found that
-the bullet holes made by the two shots were only two inches apart.
-Both were shots that would have killed the sheep in a few moments.
-This merely meant that Jack's had not given the animal a shock
-sufficient to throw it to the ground.
-
-When they had butchered, they found the sheep very fat, and neither
-Jack nor Joe liked the idea of leaving the greater part of it up
-here on the mountain to waste. "I'll tell you what we'll do, Jack,"
-said Joe, "let's each of us take one of the shoulders and try to
-carry that down to camp, and then to-morrow we can come up here
-with the horses and see if we can get the rest of it down. We can
-tell as we go home what sort of a trail there will be up here for
-a horse. Of course we can't get him up here over these cliffs that
-we climbed, but maybe by following down the stream that runs out of
-this basin we can find a horse trail."
-
-When the boys got into camp that night they were both pretty tired.
-They told Hugh what they had done, and that it was impossible to
-get a horse up as they had gone. Of course there might be some
-other way of climbing the hills.
-
-"Well," said Hugh, "now I'll tell you what we'll do to-morrow:
-we'll take a pack horse, and all of us go up there on foot, and
-we'll take the horse as far as we can, and when we can't get him
-any further, why of course we'll have to leave him. Then we can
-bring the meat down, or most of it, on our backs, and when we get
-to the horse, put it on him, and so get it all to camp."
-
-"Well, Hugh," said Jack, "let's do that; but I tell you, that sheep
-is awful heavy. I had all I wanted to carry one of those shoulders
-down, and of course the hams will be twice as heavy as the
-shoulders. I don't believe either Joe or I can carry those hams."
-
-"Oh, well, we don't any of us know what we can do until we try. I'd
-like to stretch my legs on the mountains, and I'll see what we can
-do toward bringing in the meat to-morrow."
-
-While breakfast was being cooked next morning Hugh told the boys
-to go out and bring in the dun horse, for he was the stoutest and
-toughest animal in the bunch, and besides that, Hugh thought him
-the best climber.
-
-Before starting, Hugh had the boys point out as nearly as possible
-the direction from which they had come the night before, and then
-swinging off down the hill, he worked up on the mountain, the
-others following close behind. Studying each steep ascent as they
-approached it over the more or less level bench below, he avoided
-a number of the rock climbs that the boys had made the day before,
-and several times led the horse up through ravines where Jack would
-not have supposed it possible for any animal except a sheep or a
-deer to pass. Jack noticed, too, Hugh's method of climbing. While
-he walked briskly across the level and gently sloping country, he
-climbed steep ascents rather slowly and stopped frequently. The
-boys, of course, did just as he did, and Jack noticed that he was
-not nearly so tired or so out of breath as he had been during the
-climb of the day before.
-
-During one of the rests which they made just after reaching a
-bench, Jack said, "I wonder why it is, Hugh, that I can climb so
-much better to-day than I could yesterday. Yesterday I lost my wind
-all the time, and it took me a long time to get it back. Every
-time I climbed up one of these steep places, when I got to the top
-I gave out, and had to throw myself down and pant for a long time
-before I could go on. I suppose it's because I've been riding so
-much, and doing but little on foot."
-
-"Yes," said Hugh, "I reckon that has something to do with it; but
-how did you climb yesterday? Did you hurry on and try to get to the
-top of each cliff quick, going as fast as you could, and then stop
-and rest for a long time?"
-
-"Yes, that's the way we did. We wanted to get up to the top as
-quickly as we could, and see what was over the next hill."
-
-"Well," said Hugh, "that's natural, but I don't think that's the
-way to climb 'round among the mountains. You get along as fast,
-and I think easier, if you go more slowly and make frequent stops,
-but have them short ones. If you go hurrying all the time, you get
-all blown by the hard work you're doing, and then when you have to
-stop, you have to stop a long time, and after you've rested for a
-long time you don't feel much like getting up and going on again;
-you're all tired out.
-
-"It always seems to me," he went on, "better to climb a little way
-and then stop and take a few deep breaths, and then go on a little
-way further, and then stop and breathe again. In that way you are
-not nearly so tired at any time, and the whole climb is easier for
-you. I have scrambled 'round considerable in the mountains myself,
-and that is the way I've learned to climb. You watch through the
-rest of the day, and see if you don't find it easier on you than it
-was yesterday."
-
-"I will," said Jack. "It seems a good deal easier so far, but
-then we haven't climbed anywhere near as steep places as we did
-yesterday."
-
-"That's another thing you want to learn," said Hugh: "when you're
-climbing the mountains, try always to pick the easiest road; it's
-a good deal less trouble to go 'round and take the easy slopes,
-even if it's twice as long, than it is to buck right against the
-steep face of a hill. Of course there's lots of places where there
-are no easy slopes, and you've got to go up over bad steep sliding
-shell-rock, and to climb up straight cliffs; but when you can do
-it, it pays to take the easy ways."
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XV
-
-A CHARGING GRIZZLY
-
-
-They were now getting high up in the mountain, and pretty near,
-Jack thought, to where the sheep was. The horse was still with
-them, and it astonished Jack to see that Hugh found a means of
-getting him up or around every cliff or rock slide that they met.
-At length they were so near the top that, after speaking with Joe
-about it, Jack told Hugh that he thought they were pretty near the
-game. One more high cliff should bring them to the little basin in
-which the sheep lay.
-
-"Well, boys, if you're sure of that," said Hugh, "we'll leave
-the horse here, and maybe we can pack the meat down to him. It's
-getting to be pretty steep and pretty rocky under foot, I don't
-want to take him any further than we must."
-
-"Well," said Joe, "I think we're right close now--that it's just
-over this little bluff ahead of us."
-
-Hugh twisted the horse's rope around a little bush that grew on the
-hillside, and then turning to Joe said, "Well, Joe, go ahead, and
-take us up to it." Joe started, and they were soon at the ridge;
-but just before passing over it, Joe made a motion with his hand,
-and sank back out of sight, and whispered to Hugh, "There's a bear
-at the sheep."
-
-"Sure?" said Hugh.
-
-"Sure," said Joe.
-
-"Well, how can we get at him?" asked Jack, who had pushed up beside
-Hugh.
-
-"The same way we did at the sheep, I guess," said Joe. "It don't
-look very far from here. You take a look, Hugh." Hugh climbed
-up, and cautiously raising his head, looked for a few seconds,
-and lowering it again said, "Well, boys, we've got more than we
-bargained for; there's two bears there, a big one and a little one.
-Now, let's go 'round to the left here, and get behind those rocks
-and a little above them, and then we'll have a chance to look at
-them and see what we'll do."
-
-They went back down the ravine, and then a little way around and
-again climbing the rocks, found that they could see the basin in
-which the sheep lay, and hurrying forward, they soon reached its
-rim and looked down on the spot.
-
-Sure enough, there were two bears, tearing away at the sheep's
-carcass, and seeming greatly to enjoy themselves. They looked like
-mother and cub, and to Jack the mother looked pretty big. They had
-mauled and partly eaten the fore part of the sheep's carcass, and
-had dug into its belly, gnawing the flanks.
-
-The cub paid no attention to anything, and was eating greedily, but
-the larger bear stopped feeding every few moments and looked in all
-directions, and throwing up her head seemed to snuff the breeze.
-Fortunately, the wind was blowing from the southeast, and so up the
-stream, and there was no danger that the animal would detect the
-presence of human beings; yet she seemed uneasy, and more or less
-suspicious.
-
-"Well, boys," said Hugh, "what do you want to do? I expect you want
-to kill them bears."
-
-"Yes, indeed, Hugh," said Jack, "of course we want to kill them."
-
-"Hide's no good now," said Hugh, "they're in summer coat, and all
-sunburned, and the winter coat isn't started."
-
-"Oh, Hugh," said Jack, "you don't mean you want to let those bears
-go. Why look how they've torn our sheep to pieces. Why they ought
-to be killed for that, if for nothing else."
-
-"Well, well, well," said Hugh, smiling, "you are an unreasonable
-creature. Do you expect if you leave meat out on the mountain that
-bears, or wolves, or Indians, or white people either, are going to
-pass it by and not use it? How do you suppose those bears knew that
-you were coming back?"
-
-Jack saw that Hugh was making fun of him, and said, "Well, how
-shall we take them, Hugh?"
-
-"Fix it any way you like. Suppose you take the old bear and Joe the
-cub; and I won't fire until I have to."
-
-"All right," said Jack, "but wouldn't you rather fire? I've had
-some hunting, and so has Joe since we've been out, and you haven't
-had a shot. Wouldn't you like to kill the old bear?"
-
-Hugh laughed again, as he said, "No, I'll give that up to you. You
-take the old one, and Joe'll take the young one; but I tell you,
-the young one's hide is better than the old one's."
-
-"Oh, I don't care about that," said Jack. "What do you say, Joe,
-does that suit you?"
-
-"Yes," said Joe, "it suits me all right."
-
-"All right then, let's shoot at the word; and you count, Hugh; when
-you say three we'll both fire."
-
-"All right," said Hugh, "get ready. Are you ready?"
-
-Both boys grunted in assent. One, two, three! the two guns cracked
-at the same instant. The smaller bear fell over, and then sprang
-to its feet, screaming dismally, and ran along the hillside. The
-larger one turned her head quickly and bit at the place at which
-Jack had fired, and then, without a moment's waiting, came rushing
-toward the spot over which the smoke of the two rifles still hung.
-
-"Hurrah, boys!" said Hugh, with more interest than Jack had ever
-seen him show. "Here she comes; get ready, and shoot again." The
-two boys, having reloaded, fired, but both hurriedly, and the bear
-made no pause, but kept galloping toward them at tremendous speed.
-She was now within thirty or thirty-five yards, and Hugh, saying,
-"Scatter out if she keeps a-coming, and keep shooting," raised
-his rifle to his shoulder and fired; and as he did so, the bear
-crumpled up and fell to the ground, and after a few struggles, lay
-still; but for several moments all three stood with loaded guns,
-waiting to see what she would do.
-
-"She was a tough one," said Hugh, "but I reckon that neither of you
-boys hit her a second time to do any harm to her. You were a little
-excited, I guess, and shot before you got your sights rightly
-drawed. I tell you when a bear is coming for you, that isn't the
-time to get excited. If you get excited when a deer or antelope is
-running away from you, that's all right, but when a bear is coming
-to you, you want all your wits.
-
-"But what became of your bear, Joe," he continued.
-
-"I don't know," said Joe; "last I saw of him he was going over that
-ridge, squealing a whole lot. I know just where he went over, and I
-can go there and look for him."
-
-"Well, you'd better," said Hugh. "But first let's see if there's
-any life left in this old lady down here." They slowly approached
-the bear, and threw stones at her, but she did not move. Moreover,
-much blood was running from her mouth and nostrils, and she was
-evidently dead. When they turned her over to skin her they saw that
-she was not a very large bear, but a grizzly. Her coat, as Hugh had
-said, was not in good order, being faded and sunburned, and with
-many thin patches. Still, Jack thought it would be worth taking
-home with him, and he and Hugh proceeded to skin her, while Joe
-went off to look for the small one.
-
-"Keep your eyes about you, son," said Hugh, as the boy started.
-"Even a little bear can scratch and bite a whole lot, if he gets
-hold of you. If you find the bear lying down, don't go up to him
-until you're sure either that it is dead or alive; and if it is
-alive, kill it."
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XVI
-
-SOMETHING ABOUT BEARS
-
-
-As they began to skin the bear, Jack said, "I want to find out why
-I didn't kill this bear, Hugh; I thought I held all right on it,
-and yet my shot never seemed to faze her."
-
-"Well, I'll tell you what I think, son. I noticed where she seemed
-to snap at where you hit her, and I reckon you forgot you were
-shooting down hill, and shot a little high, and perhaps hit a
-little far back. Now, when we get her hide off we'll see."
-
-Jack thought for a moment, and then said, "Hugh, I bet you're
-right. She made a kind of a step to one side just as I was pulling
-the trigger, and I never thought one thing about holding low
-because we were above her on the hillside. I guess if we open her
-we'll find that that shot of mine went nearer her liver than it did
-her heart."
-
-"Well," said Hugh, "I wouldn't be surprised. Of course the liver
-is a pretty deadly shot after a while, but it isn't so good as the
-heart, and, as I've told you I guess more than forty times, it's
-always better to shoot under than over."
-
-"Well," said Jack, "that was a pretty bad blunder. I feel pretty
-badly about that. I ought to have known better than to have done
-such a thing. I wonder if Joe shot over, too. I hope he'll get his
-bear, so that we can know about it."
-
-The work of skinning the bear was long and slow, and Hugh said,
-when they drew the skin out from under the animal, "Now we've got
-it, it ain't worth anything."
-
-It was found that Jack's ball had struck the bear much too far
-back, and so that it passed just under the spine, yet not quite
-high enough to cut the great vein that passes along close beneath
-the vertebrae. The bear might have lived a number of days, or even
-have recovered, with this shot alone. The heavy ball from Hugh's
-rifle had struck her in the back of the neck, and had smashed two
-of the vertebrae, and lay there flattened in the muscles of the
-neck. As Jack looked at the wound made by Hugh's ball, and then cut
-the flattened lead out and held it in his hand, he said, "Well,
-Hugh, it's mighty sure that you didn't get excited, anyhow. That
-was an awful good shot, even if it was close, and a mighty hard
-shot when you think how fast the bear was coming."
-
-"Yes," said Hugh, "of course in a case like that a man's got to
-figure close. I took the chance of striking her on the top of the
-head, or breaking her neck, or breaking her back right between the
-shoulders; but I hit just the place I wanted to hit. I don't hear
-anything of Joe," he went on; "let's walk over to that ridge and
-see if we can see him. I'd like to see the trail left by that bear,
-and maybe call Joe back if he's going too far."
-
-They walked quickly over to the ridge, and had just reached its
-top when they saw, a little way below them, the figure of Joe
-bending over something which they knew must be the bear, and going
-to him they found that he had nearly finished skinning it; and a
-few minutes help by Hugh and Jack completed the job.
-
-"That looks like good meat, Hugh," said Jack. "Is it worth while
-taking any of it along?"
-
-"Do as you like," said Hugh. "I don't go much on bear meat, myself.
-I've had to eat it, but then I've had to eat lots of other things
-that I didn't hanker after. If you like, we can take those hams
-along. The horse will have all he can carry, with the sheep if any
-of it is worth taking, and the bear skins. They've mauled that
-animal a whole lot, I reckon, and it may not be fit to carry to
-camp." Folding up the little bear skin, Joe put it on his back,
-while Hugh cut off the hams of the bear, which he said was a
-yearling, and he and Jack each taking one, they started back to
-look at the sheep. This was found in bad shape, but the greater
-part of both hams was uninjured, and cutting these off, and cutting
-away the part where the bears had gnawed, they were ready to start
-on their return.
-
-"Jack," said Hugh, "do you suppose you can carry both of these
-little bear hams? If you can, I'll take both the sheep hams, and
-then come back here and get the bear skin. But one of you boys'll
-have to come back to carry my rifle, for I reckon I can't tote both
-the skin and the gun, at least not without a rope to tie the skin
-up with."
-
-"I guess we've got to make two trips anyhow," said Jack, "there's
-too much to carry, and anyhow it isn't far."
-
-"No," said Hugh, "it isn't far." The two trips were made, and all
-the things carried to the edge of the cliff, and then Hugh said:
-"Now, I'll go and get the horse. I'd rather get him myself, for the
-smell of the bears'll maybe scare him, and I may have to fool with
-him a little. You boys get these things down; get the bear skins
-down first, and then the meat. We're likely to have some trouble
-packing that horse. I don't think he'll mind the meat, but the
-smell of the bear is likely to scare him."
-
-It proved as Hugh had said, the dun made a great fuss when
-approaching the pile which constituted the hunters' spoils, and
-after he was close to it it was necessary for Hugh to take off his
-coat and put it over the animal's head, and tie it there; and then
-Joe held the horse's rope, while Hugh and Jack packed the load.
-After the ropes were all tied, Hugh said.
-
-"Now boys, you want, both of you, to get hold of that rope, for I
-expect when I get this blind off the horse he'll buck plenty, and
-if he bucks down the hill, he's likely to turn a somersault, and
-roll, and break his neck before he stops rolling."
-
-The boys, having put their guns well up above the horse on the
-hillside, took the rope, prepared for anything. As Hugh had said,
-when the coat was taken from the horse's head he partly turned his
-head, and giving a frightened snort at the load on his back, began
-to buck. If he had gotten his head down the hill he would certainly
-have fallen, but the boys, and with them Hugh, kept his head from
-turning down the slope, and he soon tired of bucking, and though
-once or twice he staggered as if about to fall over, they managed
-to keep him on his feet. Though he bucked no more that day, he was
-still much alarmed by what he was carrying, and they were obliged
-to handle him with great discretion while going down some of the
-steep places; for, as the load pressed forward toward his neck he
-would snort loudly, and roll his eyes, as if he felt that he must
-do something to get rid of the terrifying burden.
-
-They reached camp just before dark, and all were glad to get there.
-When they stopped before the lodge, Hugh again put his coat over
-the horse's head until he was unpacked and unsaddled, and when it
-was taken off, the dun threw head and tail into the air and trotted
-out to the other horses, looking back and snorting fiercely,
-showing that his alarm was not yet over.
-
-"Well," said Hugh, "I believe if I had that job to do over again
-I'd rather carry the stuff down on my own back than fool with that
-horse. If I'd known we were going to have bear skins to pack, I
-wouldn't have taken the horse along."
-
-Before doing anything else, Hugh sent the two boys with the axe
-down into the timber, and told them to get a slender pole, like a
-lodge pole, and trim it, and bring it up to him. Then resting the
-ends of the pole on the branches of two trees, about six feet from
-the ground, he spread the bear hides over it.
-
-After supper that night the talk turned to what they had seen and
-done that day, and from that to bears. Jack had many questions to
-ask about them, some of which Hugh could not answer.
-
-"I thought bears almost always had two cubs," said Jack; "but this
-one only had one, and that you say is a yearling."
-
-"Well," said Hugh, "they do 'most always have two cubs, and
-sometimes three, and sometimes four. I've heard of five, but I
-never saw more than four, and those only once. I expect this old
-bear started in with two cubs, but that something happened to one
-of them. You see, when cubs first come out they are pretty small,
-and lots of things are likely to happen to them. This old she-bear
-very likely lost one of her cubs when it was a little one. You
-notice, the one we killed is pretty good size for a yearling, and
-fat and in good order. I wouldn't be surprised if he'd had all his
-mother's milk now for over a year, and that's maybe what makes him
-so fat."
-
-"When are the cubs born?" asked Jack.
-
-"Most people think they're born about the middle of the winter,"
-said Hugh. "I know the Indians think that, and I've had one or
-two men tell me that they've come across bear dens in winter, and
-killed the mother, and found the cubs in there mighty small--no
-bigger than a young pup. Anyhow, by the time they get to travelling
-round, in May and June, they're still right small, not near so big
-as old Shep, down at the ranch. They say that if you catch the
-black-bear cubs when they're right small, they make nice pets for
-a while; but I never heard of anybody that got very friendly with
-young grizzlies.
-
-"I remember once, years ago, Joe Kipp had a couple on the
-Blackfoot Reservation, that one of the Indians had caught and
-brought in when they were right small. Joe put collars on them, and
-then forgot to take them off, and long toward the end of the summer
-both bears were like to choke to death, the collars were getting so
-small for them. I helped Joe and Hi Upham take 'em off, one day,
-and 'twas a regular circus. Those little cubs--they weren't more'n
-a foot or fifteen inches high--were awful mean, and regularly on
-the fight. They were hard to catch, too, and if you did get hold of
-them they'd turn quick as a wink and bite or scratch you. Finally,
-we cornered one of 'em, and Joe grabbed it by the ears and held it
-between his legs, while Hi held the forepaws and I loosened the
-collar; but it came pretty near scratching Joe's overalls to pieces
-with its hind feet. We did the same thing with the other one. I
-tell you they were mean little cusses.
-
-"The Indians don't like bears much; ask Joe," continued Hugh.
-
-"No," said Joe, "Indians don't like bears. Afraid of 'em. Bears
-are powerful medicine, you know, and some people won't speak about
-a bear, or won't sit down on a bear skin, and of course they
-won't eat bear meat. There's lots of stories about bears among
-the Piegans. In old times, you know, bears used to kill lots of
-Indians; and the Indians had only stone arrows, and couldn't do
-anything. If a bear took after a man, maybe the man would shoot
-three or four arrows into him, and they wouldn't much more than go
-through his hide, and just make him madder and madder all the time,
-and at last he'd just catch the man and tear him to pieces. One
-story my grandfather told me a long time ago, and I heard my uncle
-tell it again last winter. Would you like to hear it, Jack?"
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XVII
-
-THE STORY OF A MAN-KILLER
-
-
-"Yes," said Jack, "this is bully; I'd love to hear it."
-
-"Well," said Joe, "this happened a long time before the white
-people came. In those days we didn't have any guns. I expect the
-bears knew that they were stronger and better armed, and they
-weren't a bit afraid of the people. Often they wouldn't move out
-of the road if they saw people coming; but the people were always
-afraid of them and willing to let them alone. Very few men ever
-killed a bear, and those that had done so were thought brave. It
-was more to kill a bear than it was to kill two or three of the
-enemy, and a man who had killed a bear used to string its claws,
-and make a collar that he wore about his neck.
-
-"In those times we had no horses, and the only animals that we
-packed, or that hauled the travois, were the dogs; and so the
-people did not wander far over the prairie as they do to-day; they
-used to stop in one place for a long time, and did not move camp
-except for some good reason. You see, the people could pack some
-of their things on the dogs, but besides that, men and women, and
-sometimes even the children, had to carry heavy packs on their
-backs whenever they moved. In those days, a great place for
-camping in summer was the valley of Two Medicine Lodge River. You
-know where it is, Hugh?"
-
-"Yes, I should say so," said Hugh.
-
-"That was a good place. Berries grew there, big and sweet; and
-along the river were high steep bluffs, over which the hunters used
-to lead the buffalo, which were killed by falling on the rocks
-below.
-
-"One summer the people were camped there, as usual. It had been
-a good summer. All about the lodges, whichever way one looked,
-you could see only red, the red of meat hanging on the trees and
-bushes, and scaffolds, drying, above the reach of the dogs; and
-all over the ground, spread out so thick as to cover almost all
-the grass, were the skins of buffalo, elk and deer, on which were
-heaped berries, curing in the sun, to be used during the winter. No
-wonder the people were happy, and that you could hear laughter and
-singing all through the camp. They had plenty of food; they feared
-nothing. No enemies were near at hand; the Stonies of the north,
-the Kutenais and Flatheads of the west, ran away when the Piegans
-came in sight; they did not dare to wait to fight them.
-
-"It was a very hot day; there was no wind, and the sun burned down,
-so that no one could work. The lodge skins were raised, and all
-the people sat or lay in the shade, some smoking, some talking and
-others sleeping. Even the little children had stopped playing, and
-the camp was quiet. Suddenly, at the west end of the village, a
-great noise was heard, cries and screams, and wailing by women; and
-from all directions men and women and frightened children began
-running to the place, crying to each other, 'What has happened?
-Who is it that is suffering?' About two women who were seated on
-the ground a crowd had gathered. These women were mourning and
-crying and sobbing as they wailed, 'Our husband! our husband! a
-great bear seized him, and carried him away into the bushes. Oh, we
-shall never see him again.'
-
-"The chief talked to them; their relations and friends tried to
-help them, and little by little in broken words the women told what
-had happened. Early that morning, with their husband, they had gone
-up the river to pick berries. They had gone far, and the sun had
-reached the middle by the time they came to the bushes where the
-berries hung ripe and red. There were so many that it had taken
-but a little time for them to gather all they wished, and they
-had started toward home along the game trail which followed the
-stream. The women were walking ahead, their husband following, and
-were crossing a grassy opening between two points of trees, when
-suddenly the husband shouted to them, 'Run, run fast to the nearest
-trees; a bear is coming.'
-
-"Looking back, they had seen their husband running as fast as he
-could, and behind him a whitish colored bear, so large that it
-seemed almost as great as a full grown buffalo bull. Its mouth was
-wide open, and they could see its long white tusks as it raced over
-the grass with great jumps. The women dropped their berry sacks and
-ran as fast as they could. Their husband was now close behind them,
-and kept urging them on; but fast as they ran, the bear ran faster,
-and the husband, seeing that it would soon overtake them, had
-once more shouted to them to 'run fast,' and then had stopped to
-face the bear, calling out that he would try to save them. Just as
-they reached the trees they heard a fierce growl, and looking back
-saw that the husband had shot an arrow into the bear, but before
-he could shoot another, the beast was upon him, threw him down,
-and taking him by the shoulder dragged him to the timber near the
-river. The women had continued to run, and had come to the camp as
-fast as they could.
-
-"When they had told their story, a Kutenai woman, a captive,
-who had learned to speak Blackfoot, spoke and said, 'This bear
-is surely he whom my people have named Man-eater. He is a great
-traveler. One summer he may be living in the valley of the
-Beaverhead, and the next season perhaps he will be found on the
-Elk River of the north. The Kutenais, the Flatheads, and all the
-mountain people know him too well. He likes the flesh of human
-beings better than that of game, and has killed many of us. In vain
-the hunters have pierced his sides with their sharpest arrows.
-They cannot harm him, and we think that he possesses some strong
-medicine, and cannot be killed. Indeed, now they no longer try to
-kill him, but as soon as he appears, they move camp, and travel a
-long distance to some other place. Listen to my words: tear down
-your lodges now, pack the dogs, and move away at once, before he
-shall kill more of you.'
-
-"That night the chief and all his warriors talked together about
-all this, and after they had counciled for a long time, they said,
-'We are not Kutenais, to run away from a bear. We will go to hunt
-this animal, and avenge the death of our friend.' The next day
-they started, many brave warriors, and when they reached the park
-they placed some of the strongest and best bowmen at the upper end
-of the bottom, while the rest went through the timber to drive it
-toward them. They found the body of their friend, partly eaten,
-but there was no sign of the bear; he had disappeared. It seemed
-as if such a large and heavy animal must leave behind him a plain
-trail of weeds crushed down, grass flattened, deep marks of feet in
-soft and sandy places; but from where he had eaten that poor man no
-signs were seen.
-
-"Why did they not listen to the Kutenais woman's words! The very
-next day, almost at the edge of the camp the great bear killed two
-women and carried one of them away to feast upon, as he had before
-done with the man. In the camp the screams of the poor women were
-plainly heard, but before the men could arm themselves and rush to
-the place, they were dead.
-
-"Now the whole camp turned out, every man; and making a ring about
-the point of timber, they all drew toward its center. They moved
-slowly, carefully, each man with his arrow fixed on the string, and
-said to each other, 'Surely now this bear will not escape.'
-
-"A thicket of close-set willow stems grew beneath the great
-cottonwoods, and from a clump of these willows the bear sprang on
-one of the men, and crushed his head with a single blow of his
-paw. 'Here he is,' cried those nearby, and they let fly their
-arrows into its sides, as the bear stood growling and tearing the
-dead person; but when the arrows struck him the bear sprang here
-and there among the men, turning like a whirlwind of fur, while
-his claws cut and his jaws snapped; and four more men fell to the
-ground dead or dying. The people all ran away.
-
-"Now there was great sorrow and mourning in the camp. After a
-little time some of the men ventured back into the timber, and
-brought away the bodies of their companions; and the women,
-wrapping them in robes, lashed them on scaffolds in the trees, as
-was the old way. Then at last they listened to the words of the
-Kutenai woman. The lodges were pulled down, everything was packed
-up, and the tribe moved southward, to the banks of the Big River.
-Six long days they were on the trail, and the man-eater did not
-trouble them again. Perhaps he did not wish to follow them; perhaps
-some one of the arrows shot into him had killed him. So the people
-talked; but the Kutenai woman laughed. 'You may be sure,' she said,
-'that he is not dead. The arrow has not been made that will reach
-his heart. His medicine is strong.'
-
-"All through the winter the people talked of what had happened, and
-of the camping place under the cliffs of Two Medicine Lodge River.
-There was no place where it was so easy to kill meat as there, and
-when spring came they moved back there once more. The day after
-they had camped, the hunters went out, up and down the valley, and
-found the buffalo and elk and deer as plenty as ever; but they saw
-no sign of the great bear.
-
-"The next day the chief's son went out with his mother and sister,
-to watch for them while they dug roots, and as they were going
-along, without any warning the great bear sprang from a thicket by
-the trail, struck the young man before he could draw an arrow, and
-carried him away without a glance at the women, who stood silent in
-their fear.
-
-"When the chief was told what had happened, he was almost crazy
-with anger and sorrow. He ordered all the men in the camp to
-go with him to the place. But not one of them would go. 'It is
-useless', they said; 'we are not fools to throw away our lives
-trying to kill an animal whose medicine is so strong that he cannot
-be killed with arrows.' The chief begged and threatened them, but
-no one would go with him to recover the body of his son. All feared
-the bear. That day camp was broken, and the people once more moved
-away from the place that they loved best of all their camping
-grounds. It was no longer theirs. The bear had driven them from it.
-
-"From that day the chief seemed different. Now he no longer laughed
-and made jokes and invited his friends to feast with him. Instead,
-he kept by himself, seldom speaking, eating little, often sitting
-alone in his lodge, and thinking always of the dear son who had
-been taken from him. One day he took his daughter by the hand,
-and went out to the center of the camp, and called all the people
-together. When all had come, he said to them, 'My children, look
-at this young woman standing by me. Many of you here have tried to
-marry this daughter, but she has always asked me to allow her to
-remain unmarried, and I have always said that she should do as
-she wished. Listen: I am still mourning for the death of my son.
-Now, I call the Sun, who looks down upon us, and who hears what I
-am saying, to hear this: whichever one of all you men that shall
-go out and kill that bear, to him I will give my daughter for his
-wife.' Then he turned to the girl, and said to her 'Have I spoken
-well, my daughter? Do you agree to my words?' The girl looked at
-him, and then said aloud, 'Since you wish it, I will marry the man
-who will kill that bear, and will thus wipe away our tears.'
-
-"Then the girl hurried back to her father's lodge.
-
-"All through the camp now the only thing talked about was the offer
-the chief had made, and the young men were trying to think how it
-might be possible to kill this bear; yet none of them said that he
-intended to try to marry the girl, for they all believed that the
-bear could not be killed.
-
-"There was one young man who, when he heard the words of the chief,
-was glad. Ravenhead was very poor, he had not a single relation,
-and as far back as he could remember he had lived as best he
-could. That means that he had been often hungry, and had worn poor
-clothing, and had often lain shivering through the winter nights;
-that he had run errands for every one, and had often been scolded.
-Now he was grown up; he had gone out to dream for power, and had
-become a warrior. His dream had been good to him, and in his sleep
-there had come to him a secret helper, who had promised to aid him
-in time of danger and of need. For a long time the young man had
-loved the daughter of the chief, but he knew that one so poor as
-he could never hope to marry her. Sometimes when he happened to
-pass her on the trail, as she was going for water or as she walked
-through the camp, she seemed to look at him kindly and as if she
-were asking him something; yet she never spoke to him, but hurried
-by, and he was always afraid to speak to her; yet sometimes he used
-to ask himself what her kind looks meant.
-
-"But now, since the chief had spoken, it seemed as if Ravenhead
-might hope. Those words had rolled away the clouds that hung over
-him, and if he could only kill the bear, he could marry the girl.
-He determined that he would kill the bear; some way could be found
-to do it, he felt sure. Now, for a little while Ravenhead kept
-by himself, praying, thinking, planning, trying to devise a way
-by which he might kill the bear, and yet himself not be hurt.
-Four days passed, and yet in all the camp no one had said that he
-intended to try to marry the girl. This made Ravenhead glad.
-
-"And there was another thing. For four nights he had dreamed the
-same dream. In his sleep he saw the picture of a great bear,
-painted as large as if alive, upon the side of a new lodge. It was
-painted in black; the long claws, and open jaws, with their great
-white tusks, showed plainly; and from the mouth ran back the life
-line, a green band passing from the mouth back to the heart, which
-was red. Ravenhead was sitting by the river, considering his dream
-reaching out dimly with his mind for its meaning when suddenly he
-sprang to his feet as if he had been stung, for all at once there
-had flashed upon him what seemed to be the way of success. The
-dream had shown it to him.
-
-"He turned toward the village, and there, only a step or two away,
-stood the chief's daughter, holding her water-skin, looking at him
-as she had looked before. Ravenhead stepped forward and stood near
-her. Twice he tried to speak, but the words would not come. Then he
-looked at her, and as she smiled at him, he said, 'I am going to
-hunt the great bear, and if I return I shall come to you.' The girl
-dropped the water-skin, and put her arms about his neck, as she
-said, 'I have tried to make you see, so far as a girl can, that I
-love you.' They kissed and clung to each other, there by the river;
-but soon the girl sent him from her, telling him to take courage;
-to go, and to return safe and successful. When he had gone she
-stood there by the river, and not able to see before her for the
-tears which filled her eyes, as she prayed to the Sun to protect
-the young man.
-
-"Ravenhead travelled for four days before he reached the old camp
-grounds, near the Two Medicine Lodge cliffs. He had left the
-village alone; no one but the girl had known his purpose. He came
-out into the valley, and looked up and down it, seeing nothing
-except the game, feeding peacefully, and, lashed on their platforms
-in the branches of the trees, the silent forms that the bear had
-killed. He wondered if he, too, was to become a prey of this
-medicine animal.
-
-"All that day Ravenhead walked about the valley, looking for the
-bear, keeping in the open timber or along its borders, where he
-could look over the parks and the slopes of the valley. He did not
-pass close to the thickets of brush, or to sloughs of tall grass,
-where the bear might lie hidden. On his back, in case and quiver,
-were his bow and his arrows; only three of these, for he had been
-too poor to trade for more, and he would not beg for any. He
-carried also a pouch of dried meat, that he had killed and roasted
-the day before, and a little bag of small stones.
-
-"Although he kept looking until dusk, he did not see the bear, and
-then, building a platform of poles in a tree, he lay down on it and
-slept. That night, in his dream, he again saw the picture of the
-bear; and as he was looking at it, his secret helper came to him,
-and pointing at it said, 'Thick fur, tough hide, hard muscle, and
-broad ribs may stop the sharpest arrow. The easy way to reach the
-heart is down through the throat.'
-
-"This was what had come to him so suddenly the day he sat thinking
-and planning by the riverside back of the village. He did not
-believe that this bear had powerful medicine, or that he could not
-be killed. If he only could shoot an arrow down its throat, he
-believed that he would be successful.
-
-"As soon as day had come, Ravenhead climbed down from the tree, and
-again began to search for the bear, hopefully now, yet constantly
-praying to the Sun to grant him success.
-
-"It was yet early in the morning when he saw the great bear, lazily
-walking across a little park toward the river, and stepping out
-from the shelter of the timber, Ravenhead shouted to attract its
-attention. The bear reared up at the sound; then Ravenhead first
-saw how great he was; and as the bear stood there on his broad hind
-feet, he turned his head slowly, this way, that way, smelling the
-air. Ravenhead waved his robe, and shouted again, calling the bear
-coward and other bad names; and presently the bear slowly dropped
-down on all fours and came toward him. The young man had gone out
-some little distance into the park, but now he began to go back
-toward the timber, and as he went faster, so did the bear, until
-both were running very fast, and the bear was gaining. To the
-young man, looking back, it seemed scarcely to touch the ground;
-and it drew nearer and nearer, though he was running as fast as he
-could. Presently, he could hear the bear pant, and just as he did
-so he reached the foot of the nearest tree. Almost in an instant
-he was up among the branches, but he was not too soon. The claws
-of the bear almost grazed his heels, and tore away a great piece
-of the bark. From the limb on which he sat, Ravenhead, panting for
-breath, looked down at the bear as it sat at the foot of the tree.
-The beast was huge, its head monstrous, its eyes little and mean,
-and from its mouth, in which the long white teeth showed, the foam
-dripped down over its neck and shoulders.
-
-"The young man drew his bow from its case, and fitted an arrow
-to the string, and then taking a stone from his sack, threw it
-down, hitting the bear on the nose. The bear jumped up, growling
-with rage and pain, and then came a shower of stones, one after
-another, hitting him on the head, the body, and the paws, and each
-one hurting. He bit at the places where they struck, growled, and
-tore up the ground, and at last rushed to the tree, trying to drag
-it down, or to climb up it, reaching up as far as he could, in his
-attempt to seize his tormentor.
-
-"Here was the chance that Ravenhead had been planning for, praying
-for, waiting for. He bent far over toward the bear, and drawing
-the arrow to its head, drove it with all his might down the bear's
-gaping throat. The great jaws shut with a snap, the growl died away
-to a wheezing cough, and then, after a moment, while the blood
-streamed from his nose and his lips, the great bear sank back to
-the ground. His gasping breath came slower and slower, and then,
-with a long shudder which almost frightened Ravenhead, so strong
-was it, he died."
-
- * * * * *
-
-"There was great excitement in the village; people running to
-and fro and calling to one another; women and children standing
-in groups and pointing to a young man who was entering the camp.
-Ravenhead had returned, weary, bloody, and dusty, and staggering
-under the weight of the head and part of the hide of the great
-bear. The people gathered about him, calling out his name and
-singing songs of what he had done, and followed him to the door of
-the chief's lodge, where he threw down the heavy burden. The chief
-came out, and put his arms about him, and led him inside, and gave
-him the seat at his left hand. The chief's daughter set food before
-him; she did not speak, but her face was happy. The young man told
-the chief how he had killed the bear, and while he was talking,
-the women hurried to make a sweat lodge for him, and when it was
-ready, with the chief and the medicine men, he entered it and took
-a sweat, purifying his body from the touch of the bear. Then,
-after the sweat had been taken, and the prayers said, and he had
-plunged in the river, they all returned to the lodge, just as the
-sun was setting. The chief pointed to a new lodge, set up near his
-own. 'There is your home, my son; may you live long and happily.'
-Ravenhead entered and saw his wife.
-
-"Without, the people were dancing around the scalp of the bear.
-They were happy, for the death of the bear had wiped away the tears
-of those whose relations he had killed."
-
-"That's a splendid story, Joe," said Jack. "That's about the best
-story I ever heard. I wish I could remember it to tell it when I
-get back east, the way you tell it."
-
-"Yes," said Hugh, "that's a mighty good story, and mighty well
-told. Who did you hear it from, Joe?"
-
-"I heard it first from Four Bears, and then afterwards I heard my
-uncle tell it."
-
-"Well," said Hugh, "you told it mighty well, but I don't wonder
-much, for Four Bears is about the best story teller I ever heard.
-But you remember it mighty well, and tell it well. It's a right
-good story.
-
-"Now, boys," he added, "I think to-morrow we'll pack up and go a
-day or two further down the creek here, and then see what turns up.
-These horses of ours have filled themselves up pretty well now, and
-are able to go along all right, and we might as well go on a little
-further. So, say we pack up to-morrow morning."
-
-"All right," said the boys, and they went to bed.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XVIII
-
-JACK'S FIRST MOOSE
-
-
-Travel down the stream next day was easy. The valley widened out,
-and the hills on either side grew lower. Twice during the march
-they came to broad meadows, partly overgrown with willows, old
-beaver meadows, Hugh said; and instead of going through them they
-went around close to the hills, so as to avoid any possible trouble
-from miry spots.
-
-After supper that night at camp Hugh said to the boys, "I reckon
-pretty quick we'll turn off south and follow up some creek, so as
-to get over to the Divide, and cross down onto Sweetwater. If I
-ain't mistaken, before we get much further along we'll strike a big
-stream coming in from the south, and when we do, we've got to turn
-and follow that up. I've heard tell of a little town off here to
-the south, but I don't know where it's at, and we don't want to go
-to it, anyhow."
-
-About noon next day they began to see a wide valley opening up to
-the south, and Hugh told them that this must be the creek he had
-been looking for. They did not follow the stream down to where
-the river from the south joined it, but cutting across southwest,
-climbed the hill, and journeyed through beautiful green timber
-in the direction in which they wished to go. Several times they
-came on beautiful mountain lakes lying in the timber, and while
-passing one of these Hugh stopped and pointed to the ground, and
-when Jack came along he saw there a track which he knew must belong
-to a moose. He wished that he might get a shot at a moose, and
-kept his eyes wide open as they journeyed along, but saw nothing.
-Two or three times during the day they rode near enough to the
-river they were following up to hear its rushing, and the noise of
-water-falls, but they could not see them. Hugh did not seem to be
-following any road at all,--there was not even a game trail,--but
-he wound in and out among the timber, keeping in the general
-direction from which the river came. About the middle of the
-afternoon he turned to the left, and worked down into the valley
-of the stream, which, though often narrow, sometimes spread out
-and showed charming little park-like meadows, in one of which they
-stopped to camp. After camp had been made, the horses attended to,
-and supper eaten, Jack said to Hugh, "Are there many moose in this
-country, Hugh?"
-
-"Well," said Hugh, "I don't know exactly what you call many. There
-used to be plenty here, and I expect if a man was hunting he might
-run across one once in a while. Of course moose stick close to the
-timber and the brush, and you don't see them as easily as you do
-the elk, that feed on the bald hillsides or on the prairie."
-
-"I'd like mighty well to get a shot at one," said Jack.
-
-"Well," said Hugh, "it might be such a thing as you could do that,
-but you're not likely to, unless we stop for a day or two to hunt.
-We can do that most any time now, if we feel like it. We've got
-over the ridge, and there's no danger of any snow falling, to stop
-us, but of course it's getting cooler all the time. If you're going
-to kill an animal for meat you'd better kill a cow. On the other
-hand, if you want a big head, why of course you'll kill a bull;
-but the bulls are pretty poor eating now; they were better two
-weeks ago, just like the elk was. We've got quite a little way to
-go yet, and of course we've got to have meat to eat; but, on the
-other hand, we've got the hams of that sheep, and the piece of that
-little bear, and we're going through a good game country all the
-way, so that I wouldn't kill anything more until we need it."
-
-"Well, Hugh, we've had lots of hunting; let's not kill anything
-more until we need it. Maybe there'll be a show down on the
-Sweetwater to get a moose."
-
-"Well," said Hugh, "maybe there will be; yet this is a better place
-than that. But we'll be in good moose country for quite a way yet,
-and maybe you'll get a chance to kill a moose, if you want to very
-bad."
-
-The stream that they were following up grew smaller and smaller,
-yet Hugh continued to follow it, and in the same southerly
-direction. He told the boys that this stream headed in the Divide,
-between Wind River and Sweetwater, and that when they came to the
-head of this creek it was only a short distance over to others
-running into some of the heads of the Sweetwater.
-
-"It ain't far, and it ain't a high climb," he continued, "and
-after we strike the Sweetwater, it's a plain trail right down to
-the Platte, and then across that is home. I don't rightly know how
-far it is, but I reckon it's not far from two hundred miles."
-
-"That means ten days then, Hugh, does it?"
-
-"Well," said Hugh, "you might call it ten days. Of course that
-means if we don't have any trouble. If we should get into any
-difficulties, or lose a horse or two, or something of that kind, it
-might take us longer."
-
-Three days later they had crossed over the Divide, between the Wind
-River and Sweetwater drainages, and were making their way through
-the timber down toward the Sweetwater. Camp had been made early.
-One of the pack horses had hurt its foot during the day, and had
-gone lame, and Hugh wanted to rest the animal for a day or two;
-otherwise it might become so lame that he would have to leave it
-behind. About the middle of the afternoon, Joe and Jack started out
-from camp to hunt, Joe taking the hills to the right of the camp,
-and Jack those to the left.
-
-It was pleasant going through the green timber so quietly as to
-make no sound, and watching constantly between the tree trunks, to
-see the motion of any living thing that might appear. There were
-a few birds in the upper branches of the trees, and now and then
-a grouse walked out of the way. Jack entered one of those level
-pieces of forest where the trees stand a little apart and the
-ground is covered with the pale green stems of the little mountain
-blueberry, which in fact is not blue in color, but red. This little
-fruit is very delicious, and a favorite food for birds and beasts.
-Jack came to a patch where the berries were thick, and sitting down
-began to strip them from the stems and eat them. Now and then he
-could hear the whistle of a meat-hawk, the harsh grating cry of a
-Clark's crow, and the shrill scream of a hawk that soared far above
-the forest. Jack thought it most pleasant, and he liked to be there
-alone and just look about him, and see and listen. It seemed to
-him a place where at any moment some great animal might step into
-sight, and begin to feed or to go about any of the operations of
-its daily life, not knowing that he was there watching and enjoying
-it all.
-
-And just as these thoughts were passing through his mind, something
-of this sort happened. It was not a very large animal, but the
-sight was a pretty one, none the less. He saw the slender stems of
-the huckleberry bushes shake, thirty or forty yards from him, and
-the shaking came nearer and nearer, and presently he was able to
-distinguish that a dozen grouse were coming toward him, feeding on
-the berries. He sat still, hardly daring to breathe, and before
-very long the birds were close to him, and in a moment more were
-all about him. He could see the old hen, larger than all the rest,
-and with frayed and faded plumage, while the young birds, but
-little smaller, were much more highly colored,--bright brown and
-white and bluish. They seemed sociable little creatures, for they
-were talking all the time, calling to each other much as a flock
-of young turkeys would call, and seeming uneasy if they became
-separated. There was one bird that wandered off quite a little to
-one side, and as the cries of its fellows became fainter as they
-passed along, the bird stood very straight, with its head much
-higher than usual, and erected the feathers of its head and neck so
-that they stood on end, giving it a very odd appearance. As soon
-as it had located the brood, the bird smoothed down its feathers
-and ran quickly toward the others. When the group got to where Jack
-was sitting, they paid no attention to him whatever. One of them
-stopped immediately in front of him, and looked carefully at his
-face, but at once resumed its feeding; and passing on both sides of
-him, they went on.
-
-Jack did not wish to frighten them, and so turned his head and body
-very slowly to look after them, and he did it so carefully that the
-birds were not alarmed, but finally passed out of sight and hearing
-without being frightened.
-
-This small adventure gave Jack very great pleasure, and he felt
-as if he had already been well repaid for his walk. Keeping on
-through the forest, he went down a gentle slope, and presently
-found himself at the edge of a little meadow, surrounding a very
-pretty lake. Nothing was to be seen there, and he stepped out of
-the bushes to go down to the water.
-
-He was going along rather carelessly, holding his rifle in the
-hollow of his left arm, when from a bunch of willows just before
-him a huge black animal with horns rushed out, and trotted up
-the meadow toward the timber. Instantly Jack knew that it was
-a moose, and throwing his gun to his shoulder, he fired at the
-animal just before it reached the fringe of willows at the edge of
-the meadow. It seemed to him that the creature flinched a little
-and then went faster, but he could not be sure. What was certain
-was that it did not fall. Taking up the track, he followed it for
-some distance through the timber--not a difficult task, for the
-moose was trotting rapidly and throwing up dirt at every stride.
-At length, however, he came to a piece of rocky ground, where the
-tracks were much harder to follow, and presently he lost them and
-had to circle two or three times to find them, and from that on the
-work of picking them out was slow. Soon, too, he noticed that it
-was growing darker, and looking at the sky he concluded that the
-sun had set. He had a mile or two to go, and as he did not wish to
-lie out during the night, he reluctantly left the moose track and
-started back for the camp. He hurried as fast as he could, and made
-good progress; but after it really got dark it was impossible to go
-very fast. He did not feel like firing his gun, because that would
-be as much as to say to the people in the camp that he was lost,
-and he did not wish to do this. He worked his way along, therefore,
-keeping toward camp as nearly as he could, but more by guess than
-anything else, because the trees stood so close that the stars
-could not be seen. However, the little light that still lingered in
-the west gave him some idea of direction.
-
-At last the ground began to slope in the direction in which he
-was going, and before long he saw in the sky the glare of a
-fire. He made sure that this was the camp, and hurrying along as
-fast as possible, frequently stumbling over rocks and sticks and
-occasionally running his face into the twigs of a dry spruce limb,
-he at last found himself near the bottom of the hill, and could see
-the gleam of the fire through the tree-trunks. Before long he was
-close to camp, and saw that Hugh and Joe had built quite a bonfire
-in front of the lodge. It was the reflection of this that he had
-seen in the sky.
-
-As he walked up to the fire, Hugh said, "Well, here you are, eh? We
-didn't know but you calculated to lie out all night."
-
-"Well," said Jack, "I didn't know but I'd have to do that; but I
-didn't want to, and so I kept going. I think perhaps I would have
-stopped and built a fire back in the timber if it hadn't been that
-I saw your fire, and kept coming."
-
-"What kept you?" said Joe.
-
-"Why, Joe," said Jack, "I saw a moose, the first moose I ever saw;
-and I had a good shot at it, running nearly straight away from me,
-and I ought to have killed it, but I didn't. I think I must have
-hit it; anyhow, I thought I saw it flinch when I shot, and it went
-through the timber in great shape. I followed the tracks quite a
-long way; but then it got dark, and I had to give it up and come
-back.
-
-"I'd like to go out and look for it to-morrow, and I will, too, if
-we stay here."
-
-"Well," said Hugh, "we'll stay here, all right enough. I want to
-rest up this horse's foot for a day or two. If I stay here and
-bathe that horse's foot, and keep him quiet, he's likely to be all
-right in two or three days. If we make him follow us over these
-hills now, he may get so that he can't use the foot at all.
-
-"Pity you didn't kill your moose," he continued; "what do you think
-was the matter?"
-
-"I don't know," said Jack. "I had as good a chance as I ever had at
-a running animal, but I think maybe I wasn't careful enough, and
-didn't hold low enough. I wouldn't be a bit surprised if I shot
-high on him. That seems to be my trouble often."
-
-"Well," said Hugh, "you'd like to go to-morrow and see if you could
-follow him up and find him. Of course he won't be good for anything
-if you do find him, but you'll have the satisfaction maybe of
-knowing that you killed him."
-
-"Won't be good for anything," said Jack; "how do you mean? You
-don't mean he'll spoil, just lying out for one night."
-
-"Why, son, didn't you know that? Is it possible you've travelled
-with me all these months and haven't learned that unless you dress
-an animal as soon as it's killed it's going to spoil? It don't make
-any difference whether the weather's cold or warm, but if you leave
-a critter with the entrails in for four or five hours it is no
-good; the meat gets tainted."
-
-"Well," said Jack, "That's news to me. I never heard that before."
-
-"Oh," said Joe, "everybody knows that."
-
-"Yes," said Jack, "everybody but me."
-
-After Jack had put his gun in the lodge, he brought out the coffee
-pot and frying pan, and ate some food, and then sat there by the
-fire, very melancholy, because he had not got his moose.
-
-"He had horns, Hugh," Jack said, "and if I should be able to find
-him to-morrow, I could bring those in, couldn't I?"
-
-"Yes," said Hugh, "the horns won't be spoiled. It's only that the
-meat wouldn't be good to eat. Were his horns big?"
-
-"No," said Jack, "I don't think they were very big; they stuck out
-on both sides. You see, I didn't get much of a look at him, except
-when he was running away. Then I could see his horns, but I wasn't
-looking at them; I was trying to pick out the place to shoot, and I
-didn't pick it out very well."
-
-The next morning Hugh told the boys that they had better go out and
-see whether they could find the moose, or another one, but warned
-them to watch the sky, and keep their direction, so that they would
-be sure to get back. He warned them also to notice carefully, and
-not get over the Divide. So long as they stayed on this side, the
-streams running down toward the Sweetwater would always help them
-to find camp; but if they crossed the Divide and got into the
-Wind River drainage, then the streams would only confuse them,
-especially as the timber was thick, and the sky could not be seen,
-and so the direction could not be told from that. Jack did not
-attempt to go back to the point where he had lost the moose tracks,
-but instead kept off to the south, in order to cross the tracks
-again, and pick them up where they were plain. He felt sure that
-he and Joe would have no trouble in following them up to the point
-where the darkness had obliged him to give them up.
-
-They soon found the tracks, and Jack, from his memory of the
-country passed over the night before, was able to follow them quite
-rapidly to the place where he had finally left them. Beyond here
-the trail was not hard to follow. The timber was thick and the
-ground damp; there was much moss, and the great hoofs of the moose
-tore this up, so that the trail was plainly visible; and here Jack
-had the first confirmation of his belief that he had hit the moose,
-for Joe called attention to a bush against which the animal had
-rubbed, and showed on it a little smear of dried blood.
-
-By this time the moose had stopped trotting and was walking; and
-after a while they saw before them lying on the pale soil, among
-the tree-trunks, a dark object stretched out, which they presently
-recognized as the moose. He had lain down here and died as he lay.
-The body was rigid now and somewhat swollen. Although the moose was
-not a large one, to Jack he seemed enormous--much taller, longer,
-and deeper through than an elk, and with a huge ungainly head and a
-swollen upper lip.
-
-"Well, Jack," said Joe, "what are you going to do now? You killed
-the moose, and you know it, but we can't take any of the meat. You
-might come up here and get the horns, if you want to pack them back
-with you, but it's no use to butcher the animal; you can see for
-yourself that the meat is spoiled."
-
-"Yes," said Jack, "I suppose it is. I'm awfully sorry; I hate to
-see a great big lot of meat go to waste like this, but there's
-nothing to be done now. I ought to have shot better."
-
-"Well, I'll tell you what let's do," said Joe: "let's go back to
-camp, and catch up our horses, and come up here and get those
-horns. In fact I guess we may as well bring a pack horse with us.
-Horns are awful unhandy things to carry on a saddle, but we can
-put the head on a pack so that it will ride well."
-
-"Well," said Jack, "we may as well do that, I think," and they rose
-to go.
-
-"I'll stick a knife in this carcass," said Joe, "and if I do that
-it will be pleasanter to work about when we get back."
-
-He plunged his knife into the animal's side and there was an
-outburst of gas; then the two boys went back to the camp.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XIX
-
-WATCHING A BEAR BAIT
-
-
-"Hello, Hugh," said Jack, as they walked up to the lodge; "we found
-the moose."
-
-"Well, you've done pretty well," said Hugh. "I thought maybe he'd
-go so far, even if you'd hurt him bad, that you wouldn't find him
-at all."
-
-"No," said Jack, "we found him easily enough. He didn't go very far
-beyond where I had to leave the trail last night. But it is just as
-you said; the meat is spoiled; he's no good to eat.
-
-"His horns are not very big, but Joe suggested that we should come
-back here and get our horses and a pack horse, and go up and bring
-in the head and horns."
-
-"Why, sure," said Hugh; "why not do that? I expect you'd like to
-take it home, seeing it's the first moose you ever killed."
-
-"Yes," said Jack, "I should like it."
-
-"Now, I'll tell you what you do," said Hugh. "Do you remember how I
-cut off that sheep's head?"
-
-"Why, yes," said Jack, "I remember that you cut it off close down
-to the shoulders, but I don't remember just how you cut the skin."
-
-"Well," said Hugh, "look here now; I'll show you," and sitting down
-on the ground he drew a little diagram with the stick, explaining
-to Jack that he should stick the knife into the moose's head
-immediately behind the horns, split the skin down on the nape of
-the neck to the shoulders, then make a cut at right angles to the
-first one, running down outside of one shoulder, across under the
-chest, and up outside of the other shoulder. Then, by skinning
-away from the top of the neck, the hide of the whole neck could be
-drawn forward; the head cut from the neck where the first vertebrae
-joins the skull; and afterward, by cutting the skin from where
-the neck-cut began between the horns, out on each side to each
-horn and around its base, the whole skin of head and neck could be
-taken off, and the skull cleaned, with the horns attached to it.
-Afterwards in mounting, the skin could again be stretched over the
-skull, so that the head could be hung on the wall.
-
-It did not take the boys long to saddle up their riding horses and
-a pack animal, and when they were on horseback the distance to the
-moose was not great. When they reached it they tied their horses,
-and walked up to the carcass to begin the skinning. But before they
-did anything, Joe said, "Hold on, Jack! look a-here! There's been
-a bear here since we've been gone;" and sure enough, the tracks of
-a middle-sized bear were seen about the carcass, and the hole made
-by Joe's knife was wet around the edges, as if some animal had been
-licking it. Jack looked all around, but of course nothing living
-was to be seen now.
-
-"Now, I tell you what," said Joe; "let's get this head off, and
-go away, and I wouldn't be surprised if we could come back here
-to-morrow and get a shot at a bear. You know, Hugh said we
-weren't going to move for two or three days, and if that's so, why
-shouldn't we come back here and watch."
-
-"It isn't a very good place for that, is it?" said Jack, "right
-in here among the timber; we'd have to be close to the moose, and
-likely enough a bear would see us or smell us, before we could see
-it."
-
-"That's so," said Joe; "it's a pretty poor place, but before we go
-we'll look around and see if we can find any way to hide." The boys
-were somewhat excited at this prospect, and at once set to work to
-skin the moose head. A long slit was made down through the thick
-hair on the nape of the neck, back to the shoulders, and then a
-cross cut down to the moose's chest; then both the boys, getting
-hold of the head, tried to turn it over, but they were not strong
-enough to do that. Then they tried to lift the moose's head up in
-the air, in order to get under it, and to make the cross cut on
-the other side close to the ground. They did not succeed very well
-in this either; but finally, after raising the head as high as
-they could, Joe got a stick and propped it in this position. Then,
-getting a longer stick they tugged, strained, and kept raising
-the head higher and higher, until finally the fore part of the
-shoulder was pretty well exposed. They made the cross cut, but for
-six or eight inches it was quite ragged. However, they succeeded in
-completing the cut, and then worked more rapidly, and before very
-long had the skin off the whole neck and turned so far toward the
-head that the back of the skull could be seen. Then, Joe cutting
-down close to the skull so as to sever the ligament of the neck,
-they twisted the skull, disjointed the neck, and after that it was
-a mere matter of cutting through the flesh. After the head had been
-cut off it was pretty heavy, much more than one boy could lift,
-besides being unwieldy and hard to handle.
-
-They dragged the head a little way from the moose, and then stood
-looking at it, for both were a little tired.
-
-"Now, look here, Jack," said Joe, "what's the use of packing all
-this stuff back to camp; why not finish the job here, and take the
-skull back pretty clean?"
-
-"Yes," said Jack, "it's a pretty long job, but we've got to do it
-either here or at the camp, and we might as well do it here. I
-guess we'd better use our jackknives to cut around these horns."
-Sitting down on the ground they did the work of making the crosscut
-to the horns, and then they cut round the horns, close up against
-the burr. The hide was thick and tough, and the blades of the
-knives were small; but, on the other hand, the knives were sharp,
-and before very long they had completed this. Then they both worked
-at skinning the hide down over the head, cutting through the
-gristle of the ears, and going very carefully about the eyes; and
-at last, after midday, the skin of the head was free from the skull
-and was dragged off to one side.
-
-"There," said Joe, "that's a good job, and now we'll cut off all
-the meat we can from the skull, and pack the horse, and go back to
-camp. I'm getting hungry. I don't believe this tongue is spoiled;
-we may as well take that with us." The remaining work was not
-long, and lashing the skull on the pack saddle, they set out for
-camp.
-
-Hugh hailed them, when they got in, with an expression of surprise,
-saying, "Why, you done the whole job, didn't you? I supposed I'd
-have an afternoon's work over that head, skinning it out, and
-cleaning the skull."
-
-"Well," said Jack, "Joe suggested that we should not make two bites
-of the cherry, so we did the work right there. But, say Hugh, a
-bear had been 'round that moose, between the time we left it and
-the time we got back, and Joe says maybe we can get a shot at him.
-What do you think?"
-
-"Why, I don't know," said Hugh; "maybe you could. What sort of a
-place is it to wait?"
-
-"Not very good," said Jack; "it's right in the thick timber, and
-there's no hill, and no hiding-place anywhere nearby. We looked
-when we were coming away. But I tell you what I think, Hugh; I
-believe we could go back there, and get up into a tree, and watch
-from there; then the bear won't be likely to smell us, and maybe
-we'll be able to get a good shot."
-
-"Yes, that's so," said Hugh; "but there's one bad thing about
-getting up into a tree: it's awful noisy, and if you move much, the
-bear's pretty sure to hear you. When did you calculate to watch?"
-
-"Why, I don't know," said Jack; "we were going to ask you. It
-ought to be either early in the morning or late in the evening, I
-suppose. That's the time bears come out, isn't it?"
-
-"Yes," said Hugh, "that's the time; but in here where they're not
-much hunted, I suppose maybe they'd feed any time of day.
-
-"I tell you what I believe I'd do," he continued, "we're going
-to stop here for a day or two more and see if that horse's foot
-will get better, and suppose you don't do anything now until along
-about the middle of the day to-morrow; then you can ride up there
-and see if the bears have been working at the carcass, and if they
-have, why you can wait there until about dark, and if you don't
-get a shot you can go back again the next day, right early in the
-morning."
-
-"Well, let's do that then," said Jack.
-
-"Now," said Hugh, "take your moose-head down to the creek and put
-it in there to soak and drain, and then this afternoon you can take
-the brains out and sort of scrape the skull, and after it soaks
-there for a couple of days it'll be in good shape to dry right up."
-The next day, a little before noon, they set out to inspect the
-bait. As they started out to catch their horses, Hugh told them to
-drive in old Baldy as well, and that he would ride up there with
-them and see how the prospect looked.
-
-When they reached the moose they found a great hole torn in its
-side, and from the tracks around about, it seemed that several
-bears had been feeding there. The day, though bright at sunrise,
-had now become overcast and dull, and the air felt like rain or
-snow. Hugh surveyed the ground about the moose with some care, and
-finally said to the boys:
-
-"I don't see anything for you to do except to climb up into a
-couple of these trees; and if I were you I'd watch this afternoon,
-and if you don't get a shot, quit pretty early, at least before it
-gets plumb dark, come back to camp, and then try it again early in
-the morning. I'll take your horses down here a half a mile, and tie
-them in that little open park that we passed, where they can feed,
-but where they'll be far enough away so as not to scare the game.
-If you don't get a shot, try to get to your horses before it's
-right dark, and then you can get back to camp all right."
-
-Hugh waited until the boys had climbed the two trees, one a little
-distance to the north of the moose, the other about as far to the
-south of the carcass. He told them to cut away all the twigs that
-were close to them and would rustle if they moved, and advised them
-that they must keep absolutely still, "for" he said, "there is no
-animal so shy as a bear, and none that's more careful in coming
-up to a bait. If a bear comes, don't try to shoot at it too soon,
-let it come on until it gets right close to you; then shoot as
-carefully as you know how, and try to kill it dead, for I don't
-want you to wound a bear, and then go following it through the
-thick timber and the brush; that's dangerous, and I think foolish."
-
-The hours, after Hugh departed, seemed pretty long to the boys
-as they sat on their perches. They could not see each other, and
-of course could not talk. Both were occupied in looking over the
-ground that they could cover with their eyes, and in listening for
-any noise. The weather grew colder, and toward the middle of the
-afternoon flakes of snow began to sift down through the tree-tops.
-Then they stopped; then began again. There was snow enough to see
-as it fell, but not enough to show upon the ground.
-
-Joe was glad when he saw the snow, for he believed it would bring
-the bears out soon; but Jack did not know this, and thought only
-of the discomfort of the cold. A little breeze was blowing from the
-south, and that gave Joe the unpleasant benefit of the odor of the
-decaying moose meat; but he thought little of that, and sat there
-and watched. For a long time nothing was seen. Then suddenly, from
-behind a dead log, fifty or sixty yards from Joe, he saw the head
-of a black bear rise, and the animal stood there screwing its nose
-in all directions and snuffing the wind. It remained there for a
-long time, and then the head drew back and disappeared. Joe's rifle
-was loaded and cocked. He had fixed himself in as good a position
-as possible for shooting, and he waited. For a long time nothing
-happened, and then suddenly the bear appeared, stepping out from
-behind a tree quite close to him,--not more than thirty or forty
-yards away--and stood there, looking at first toward the moose, and
-then slowly turning its head and looking in all directions. It was
-a black bear, not very large, and yet not by any means a cub. Joe
-thought the best thing he could do was to shoot it. It stood nearly
-facing him, and when it turned its head away to the right, he aimed
-for its chest, just to the right of the bear's left shoulder, and
-pulled the trigger. The animal gave half a dozen bounds, and then
-commenced to jump into the air and come down again, and to roll
-over, and turn somersaults; while Joe kept his eyes rolling in all
-directions, to see whether there were any others.
-
-The bear's position had been such that Jack had not seen it at all.
-He was cramped and stiff, cold, tired and hungry by this time; but
-at the shot he forgot all his discomforts, and sat watching to
-see what should happen. For a moment he saw and heard nothing, and
-then, off to his left, he heard a stick break, once or twice, as if
-some heavy animal were stepping on it, and then all became silent
-again. Presently Joe appeared, walking by the moose, and came and
-stood under the tree in which Jack sat. "Well, Jack," he said,
-"I've got a bear, and I don't suppose any more will come now. We
-may as well go over and skin it, and go back to camp."
-
-"How big is it, Joe?" said Jack.
-
-"Well," said Joe, "it's small. It looked pretty big to me when I
-first saw it looking out through the trees; but when I shot it, and
-saw it lying on the ground, it didn't seem very big."
-
-Jack scrambled down from the tree, and the two boys went over
-to the bear. It was not large, but, on the other hand, it was
-better than no bear at all, and its coat was quite good: not long,
-but full, and black and glossy, and quite worth having. Jack
-congratulated Joe, and they set to work to skin the bear.
-
-Joe's shot had been a good one; he had hit exactly in the right
-place, and the ball had cut the great artery of the heart, and the
-lungs, so that the bear died almost at once.
-
-The work of skinning the animal took some little time, but it was
-not nearly dark when Joe, with the skin on his back, and Jack, with
-one of the hams in his hand, started to go to the horses. The other
-ham they hung up in a tree. The horses took them speedily to the
-camp, and they greatly enjoyed their dinner that night. Both boys
-were tired and were glad to turn in at an early hour.
-
-The next day the whole camp arose late. Hugh reported that the
-horse's leg was better, and that he thought they might as well move
-on the next day. "Now," he said, "do you boys want to go up and
-watch for bear again to-night?"
-
-"I don't know, Hugh," said Jack; "what do you think the chances
-are? Will any of them come back after one being killed last night?"
-
-"Yes," said Hugh, "I think maybe they might. Of course you can't
-tell. Maybe they might come back now, or perhaps they'll leave the
-bait alone for three or four nights, and then come back."
-
-"Well," said Jack, "I'd like to get a shot; but it's paying pretty
-dear for it to have to sit up in a tree for five or six hours, and
-pretty nearly freeze to death. I like to be doing something. I
-wouldn't mind trailing a bear or a deer or a sheep for half a day,
-but this sitting on a thin branch in the cold, and waiting for a
-bear to come to you, isn't what it's cracked up to be."
-
-"No," said Hugh, "you're right there. I don't think much of it.
-However, we might get on our horses about midday, and go up and see
-whether any bears came last night after you left. The carcass'll
-show that plain enough."
-
-When they looked at the carcass they found that a number of
-bears had evidently been there; and not only had they eaten a
-considerable part of the moose, but they had also partly eaten the
-bear that Joe had killed the night before.
-
-"Well," said Hugh, "this seems to be a regular bear playground!
-I've a good mind to come up here myself to-night, and sit in one
-of these trees, and see if I can't get a shot. It's quite a while
-since I've killed a bear, and I sort of need a bear-skin to spread
-on my bed. What do you say boys, shall we all watch here to-night?"
-
-"Yes, Hugh, let's do that; that'll be great fun,--to see who gets
-the shot, or whether any bears come."
-
-"Well," said Hugh, "I'm no way certain they'll come; they're awful
-keen-nosed, and if they should smell that we've been around here
-during the day, they won't show themselves. Now, I'll tell you what
-we might do: suppose we go off down to where we're going to leave
-the horses, and stop there for two or three hours,--nothing will
-come here very much before sundown,--and then about three o'clock
-we'll come up here, and you two boys can ride your horses right
-under the trees you're going to get into, and just climb into them
-without touching the ground at all; and I'll take the horses back
-and come up afoot, and get up into my tree. In that way there'll be
-only one set of tracks for the bears to smell."
-
-Accordingly, about three o'clock they rode back; the boys climbed
-from their horses directly into the tree; and then Hugh, taking the
-bridle reins, led the horses back and picketed them in the park.
-Then he returned, and choosing a tree about half way between the
-boys, clambered up into it, and they all sat there, patient and
-still.
-
-The boys watched and waited as carefully as the day before; but
-nothing happened until, just before sundown, the heavy report of
-Hugh's gun rang out on the silent air, and a moment later they
-heard the branches crackle as he clambered down from the tree.
-"All right, boys," he called out: "come along."
-
-The boys descended from their branches, and joining Hugh, they
-all went forward a little way, to a small open spot where a brown
-bear lay stretched on the ground, with the blood flowing from its
-nostrils.
-
-"This fellow," said Hugh, "has been fussing 'round in sight for
-about twenty minutes. He wanted to come awful bad, and yet he was
-awful scared to. I thought one time that maybe he was going around
-Jack's way, and so I didn't bother with him; but presently he came
-back and commenced to go right toward the bait, making little runs
-forward and then little runs backward, but always getting closer,
-until finally I made up my mind that I'd have to kill him. Now,
-Joe," Hugh continued, "you help me skin him, and, Jack, you go and
-fetch the horses."
-
-Not long after Jack had returned, the skin was off the bear, rolled
-up and tied behind Hugh's saddle, and they returned to camp.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XX
-
-A PUZZLING TRAIL
-
-
-The next morning Hugh put a light load on the lame horse, and they
-started down the stream. The going was fairly good, through open
-timber, and at last they came to what Hugh said was the main river,
-and followed that down. There was a good game trail all the way,
-and they went pretty fast, but Hugh stopped early because he did
-not want to tire his cripple. The horse, however, was in good heart
-and fed eagerly, and Hugh said that it was all right.
-
-For several days their journey down the Sweetwater was without
-incident. They reached the open country, where there were many
-antelope, and saw two or three bunches of elk. Several times Jack
-tried fishing in the river, but without success, as Hugh had
-prophesied, saying: "You won't find any trout in this stream,
-nor in any other stream that runs into the North Platte, without
-they've been put there. There's lot's of trout in the South Platte,
-and just as soon as you strike the tiny little creeks that run from
-springs on the other side of the Divide you can catch from them all
-the small trout you want; but there are none in the North Platte."
-
-"But why is that?" said Jack.
-
-"You can't prove it by me," said Hugh. "I don't know. I've heard
-tell that the trout in all the streams on this side of the
-mountains come from the other side;--that is, that they really
-belong on the west slope, but that somehow they got over on this
-side. Now, you take a place like Two Ocean Pass, that we heard
-about up in the Park, and other places that I have seen like that,
-where there's a low place on the Divide,--a place that often holds
-water, and from each end of which a little creek runs down, one
-going east, the other west. If the trout ran up the creek that
-goes west into this little pond on the Divide, why it might easy
-enough be that some of them would run down the creek that runs
-east. Anyhow, it's a sure thing that there are no trout in any of
-the North Platte waters that I ever saw, while in the South Platte,
-and in the Wind River, and the Bighorn, and the Yellowstone, and
-pretty much all the streams to the north, there are lots of trout.
-It always seemed queer to me that the North Platte don't have any."
-
-One night in camp, as they were sitting around the fire after
-supper, Jack said, "Hugh, tell me a bear story. We've seen a lot of
-bears this trip and killed quite a lot. Were you ever badly scared
-by a bear? Of course that old bear charged us the other day, but I
-don't suppose you were scared by it, and I wasn't; but I'd like to
-know if you were ever really scared by a bear."
-
-"Well," said Hugh, "I reckon I have been. I remember one time that
-a bear made me run pretty lively for a ways."
-
-"How was it?" said Jack.
-
-"Well," said Hugh, "it wasn't so very long ago, and I was up on
-the mountains back of the ranch trying to kill some meat. I had
-left my horse and gone quite a way without seeing anything, when
-I came over a ridge and looked down into a piece of timber. About
-a hundred yards off, lying at the foot of two or three trees, just
-in the edge of the timber, I saw a kind of a black pile, and for
-a little while I could not make out what it was. I stopped and
-looked, and presently a part of the pile got up, and a bear began
-to walk around, and then another, and then a third got up, and they
-all walked around the others that were lying there, and looked as
-if they were snarling and wanted to fight. I saw in a minute that
-there were too many bears for me to tackle and was just about to
-back off over the hill and clear out, when one of them saw me and
-started running toward me as hard as he could. I knew then it was
-no use to run, and I sort of braced myself, and got a half a dozen
-cartridges in my hand, and waited until the bear got up within
-fifteen or twenty steps of me, and then fired at it, and turned and
-ran as hard as I could. I didn't hear anything following me, and
-presently looked over my shoulder, and saw that there was nothing
-in sight; but I kept on running until I got out of wind, and then I
-went to my horse as quickly as I could. When I had mounted I went
-back, went round a little way, and rode up over the hill in another
-place and looked down, and there was nothing alive in sight. I went
-pretty carefully along the ridge until I got to the place where I
-had stood, and then I went down to where the bear had been when I
-shot. There was plenty of blood there, but that was all. Then I
-went down to the tree and found that these bears--and there must
-have been a half-dozen of them--had dug down into the ground under
-the trees and had been lying there, as a dog sometimes digs in the
-dirt and lies there to get cool.
-
-"The bears had started off together, but it was hard to tell
-just what they had done. I followed them for quite a way, and
-some of them must have left the bunch, for when I got to a big
-snow-drift--it was toward the end of June, and there were plenty
-of big drifts that hadn't melted yet--there were only three of the
-bears together. The snow-drift was hard, and I walked along over
-it, leading my horse and following the tracks. The horse hardly
-sank in at all, and my feet made no impression on the snow; but
-the big bear,--the one that was bleeding,--sank in about six or
-eight inches every step, while the two others only sank in a half
-an inch. That must have been a big one. I followed them into the
-timber, and finally they went into a place where the spruces grew
-low and so thick that you could not see through them, and there I
-gave up the trail. I didn't want that bear bad enough to follow him
-into that place."
-
-"Well, of course you never knew anything more about it than you do
-now," said Jack.
-
-"No," said Hugh, "I never knew anything about it except what I
-learned from following the trail. The bear was hit somewhere in the
-breast or neck or head; he was bleeding from the front part of the
-body; and I expect the bullet must have knocked him down, or else
-he would have followed me and likely caught me. But it was about
-the longest and fastest run that I've made in many a year."
-
-For some days they travelled down the Sweetwater, having an open
-easy road and making good progress. They passed the cañon at the
-mouth of the river where it enters into the Platte, and now felt
-that they were getting near home.
-
-One morning as they were riding along, Jack noticed the trail of
-a big bunch of horses, driven fast, going the opposite way from
-themselves and turning off into the hills to the north. He asked
-Hugh who would be driving a bunch of horses through that country,
-and where they were going; but Hugh could not tell him.
-
-"I don't know anybody, son," he said, "who would be taking horses
-through here, and I don't know where they'd be taking them to,
-without it's up to some small town north, or up to the new
-railroad, and then I don't see why they should be coming this
-way, unless perhaps they wanted to get over on Powder River and
-follow that down. The railroad, I hear, is pushing west from the
-Missouri, and it may be that some contractor came down here to get
-horses. And yet that don't seem right either. These are not work
-horses,--you can see that from their tracks,--and besides that
-there are lots of colts with them. If it was a few years back, I
-should think that a bunch of Indians had gone through; but then
-there are no travois trails, and I don't know what it is. Might
-be horse thieves; it's been so the last few years that people are
-stealing stock some."
-
-The trail came from down the river, and they had followed it for
-some miles when a dark spot seen on the bottom showed a large
-animal lying down. Hugh rode over and found it to be a dead horse.
-He waved to the boys, who followed him, and they sat there on
-their horses, looking down at it. The animal had been dead perhaps
-a day; it lay on its side, and the brand was plainly visible. As
-Jack looked at the brand he recognized it as his uncle's, and he
-looked at Hugh in perplexity to see what this could mean. For a
-time Hugh said nothing, and then getting down from his horse, he
-looked more closely at the brand, and then, re-mounting, said to
-the boys, "We'll camp right here; over in that bunch of timber."
-
-It was but little after midday, and Jack knew that something
-important must have happened, but he asked no questions, waiting
-for Hugh to speak. After they had unsaddled, and put up the lodge,
-Hugh told the boys to picket the three riding horses while he got
-dinner. Jack had told Joe about the brand, and both boys were a
-good deal excited, wondering what was coming next.
-
-After they had eaten, Hugh filled his pipe and said: "Now boys, I
-don't know what all this means, but to me it looks as if a gang of
-horse thieves had been riding our range and had driven off a bunch
-of horses, and among them some of ours.
-
-"I know that three-year-old filly lying over there perfectly well.
-She had her first colt this spring. It looks to me as if she had
-been run so hard that it killed her. Maybe she got a chance to fill
-herself up with water, somewhere back. But anyhow, there she is,
-and she came from the ranch, and what is more, she never was sold
-to anybody. She's been driven here, and driven so hard that it
-killed her. Now I am going to find out, if I can, what this means.
-I am going to see if I can find this bunch of horses, and see
-whose they are and who has got them. If they, or any part of them,
-belong to us, or came from our country, why we'll get them back if
-we can. Of course if we can't get them back, why they've got to go
-on. I don't think there are enough horses in Wyoming to pay for
-the life of either of you two boys; but if these horses have been
-stolen I reckon we can get them back, and I am mighty sure we'll
-try.
-
-"Now, presently, as soon as the horses have eaten, I am going off
-on the trail of this bunch. I want you boys to stop right here
-until I come back, and if I should not come back in the course of
-three days, I want you to go to the ranch and tell them what you've
-seen. It will be no trouble to get back home. You'll know when you
-get to Casper or to Fetterman, and you can cross the river most
-anywhere there, and then it's pretty nearly a straight shoot south.
-You and me have ridden enough around the country, Jack, so that
-you know the principal hills, and I'm sure you'll know Rattlesnake
-Mountain when you see it. You know where the ranch lies from there.
-You've got plenty of grub, and it's only a little more than two
-days hard ride to get home.
-
-"But I expect that you'll see me back here about day after
-to-morrow, in the morning, and then I'll have something to tell
-you:--either that I haven't found the stock, or else that I have:
-and what it is; and who it belongs to.
-
-"Now, I want some grub--just some of that dried meat. I won't have
-a chance to kindle a fire while I'm gone, and I've got to ride
-pretty fast and can't carry much. One thing I must have though,
-and that is your glasses, son."
-
-Jack rose and went into the lodge and brought out his glasses and
-gave them to Hugh, who opened them, looked at the clasp of the
-case, and then, shutting it and seeing that the spring was in good
-order, tied a buckskin string around it. As the sun fell toward the
-west he sent one of the boys to bring in a horse and said to him,
-"Let old Baldy stay out there, and fetch the dun; he's stronger,
-and fatter, and tougher than any of the rest.
-
-"Now, boys," he said, after he had mounted, "this next two or three
-days will be business; you want to forget you're boys, and think
-that we may have to do something pretty hard and pretty active
-before long. Don't go off hunting; don't neglect your horses; stay
-'round camp, and keep a good lookout during the daytime. If you see
-anybody coming, get your horses in close and tie them among the
-trees. Keep your riding horses on picket all the time, and at night
-keep them pretty close to the lodge." Then he rode off.
-
-"Well," said Jack, as Hugh's form grew smaller and smaller in the
-distance, "what do you suppose this means, Joe?"
-
-"I don't know," said Joe, "except what Hugh said. If he finds these
-horses belong to your uncle, why I expect maybe he'll come back,
-and we'll have to go up there and kill the man that stole them, and
-take them back."
-
-"Oh, nonsense, Joe, Hugh didn't mean anything like that. Don't you
-know, he said there weren't horses enough in Wyoming to pay for our
-lives? That means that there isn't going to be any fighting."
-
-"Well," said Joe, "maybe then if he finds they're your horses,
-we'll have to go up there and steal them, and take them back that
-way."
-
-Jack slapped his thigh with his hand, as he said, "That would be
-bully, wouldn't it? It would be real fun to steal horses, and have
-all the excitement of it, and yet know that you were not doing any
-harm, only getting back your own.
-
-"Well, anyway," he continued, "we've got to look out mighty sharp
-for things, for whatever Hugh said has got to be done. I remember
-one time when I failed to do as he told me, and I got the worst
-scare that I ever had in all my life. That was the time when
-Hezekiah and young Bear Chief caught me in swimming." Joe grinned
-appreciatively, as he said, "I heard about that a good many times."
-
-"I suppose you have," said Jack; "that's always been a good joke on
-me."
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XXI
-
-HUGH GOES "ON DISCOVERY"
-
-
-Meantime, Hugh was loping fast up the bottom of the Platte, on the
-trail of the horses. It seemed to him to have been made the day
-before; and this would agree very well with the length of time that
-the mare bearing Mr. Sturgis' brand seemed to have been dead. It
-was not easy to tell, out here in the open under the hot sun and in
-the dry wind, just when the tracks had been made.
-
-An hour or two of hard, fast riding brought him to the point
-where he had come upon the trail that morning, and he could see,
-looking ahead, that here it turned off and struck in toward the
-hills, apparently to go up one of two valleys. There was water in
-both,--not much down here on the dry bottom, but further back in
-the hills and among the timber he knew that these streams were
-running brooks, and that on both there were wide grassy meadows
-and places very likely to be chosen by people driving a bunch of
-horses, in which to stop and let them feed and rest. If he had been
-following Indians who had driven off a band of horses that they
-had stolen from an Indian camp, he would have gone carefully, for
-Indians would have left behind scouts who, from the top of some
-high hill, would have watched the back trail for at least a few
-hours; but he did not think that white men would do this. He had
-reason to think that if these were rustlers--horse thieves--they
-had gone over the range after the horse round-up was over, and
-gathering these horses, had driven them slowly, perhaps by night,
-until they had got beyond the last ranch, and then had hurried them
-along, hoping to get them out of the country without observation.
-
-On the other hand, these might not be horse thieves, but might be
-people who were driving their own stock in a legitimate way, for
-some purpose of their own; but he could not understand how this
-should be, and the presence in the bunch of an animal with Mr.
-Sturgis' brand made him feel that he must investigate.
-
-The trail led toward the westernmost of the two valleys, and Hugh
-followed it. The sun was almost down when he got well into the
-valley, but he could see that the horses were still going fast, and
-he hurried the dun along, for he was anxious if possible to find
-the herd that night. It grew dark rapidly, but still he rode on,
-galloping fast over the grassy bottom, and going more slowly only
-when he came to the crossings of streams, or to rocky ground, where
-his horse's hoofs made some noise. Of course the dun, like all
-the other horses, was unshod, so that there was no clink of iron
-against stone, to be heard at a distance.
-
-After he had ridden for three or four hours in the dark, he
-stopped, took off his saddle and bridle, and holding the rope which
-was about the dun's neck in his hand, let the animal walk about.
-It took a few bites of grass, and then lay down and rolled three
-or four times, and then getting up, shook itself. Then Hugh put
-the saddle on, re-mounted, and went forward. All the time he was
-looking and listening as hard as he could. He had gone but a little
-distance beyond this place, when suddenly he heard the whinney of a
-little colt, and stopped.
-
-Taking his horse by the bridle he walked forward, and before he had
-gone very far saw a horse standing near him, and then another, and
-presently a number of horses, and knew that he was in the midst of
-the bunch. He took a long look on every side. The valley here was
-wide, but on either side he could see the black mountains rising,
-and he did not know just how far the timber came down into the
-valley. Now he wanted to find where the camp was, and mounting his
-horse he took a long look up and down the stream on both sides, and
-there on his right, and not far off, he detected what he thought
-was the glow of a fire.
-
-Passing on north, until he had gone well above the place where he
-supposed the camp must be, he tied his horse to a little bush, and
-then walking over to the edge of the valley, close to the stream,
-he silently drew nearer to the camp. Before long he was close
-enough to see the dim light of the fire, and knew that some where
-near it must be lying the men who had the horses in charge. This
-was enough for him. He went back, got his horse, and going further
-up the stream, crossed it, and finding an open place sat down,
-holding his horse's rope in his hand until the animal had eaten its
-fill. Then, still on foot, he climbed the mountain, tied up his
-horse in a thick bunch of brush where it could not be seen, took
-off the saddle, and after eating some dried meat, went along the
-mountain side back to a point opposite the camp, and finding a
-smooth place, lay down, wrapped himself in his saddle blanket, and
-went to sleep.
-
-It was still dark when he awoke, but he sat up, stretched himself,
-and involuntarily felt in his pocket for his pipe, and then smiled
-a little as he recollected that now he could not smoke. He folded
-his blanket, and laid it behind the trunk of a tree, and then very
-slowly began to make his way down the mountain side toward the
-camp. Before he had gone far, he began to hear the calls of early
-waking birds, and to be conscious that in the little patches of
-sky that he saw from time to time the stars were growing paler.
-He went very slowly and carefully, feeling his way with hands and
-feet, never brushing against the branch of a tree, or stepping on
-a stick which might crack. The men in the camp below were probably
-fast asleep and would not notice the sounds that he might make, but
-the matter was too important for him to run any risks. After a time
-it grew lighter, and presently he could hear below him the rattle
-of the water as it flowed over the stones; and as it grew more and
-more light, the dim shadows of the horses in the open, and the dark
-outlines of the bushes on the stream were seen. The mountain side
-just over the camp was steep and thickly clothed with spruces,
-most of them of large size, but with many small ones growing among
-them. If he had himself chosen a place for these men to camp, he
-could not have selected one that would have been better suited to
-his purpose. As the light grew stronger, he worked down closer and
-closer to the camp, until he was as near it as he dared go. Then
-he began to look about for a place from which he could see it,
-for first of all he wished to discover who the men were who had
-the horses. It might be that this would at once explain the whole
-matter.
-
-After a little manoeuvering he found a place where, through the
-thin branches of a young spruce, he could look directly down into
-the camp. There were the ashes of a fire, and not far from it, on
-the smooth dry grass, were three piles, two of them covered with
-canvas such as cow punchers commonly use to wrap their beds in, and
-the other with a gray blanket. He knew that he might now have to
-wait a long time, and was prepared to exercise patience. He had set
-his gun on the hillside, against a tree, where it would not fall
-down, and at the same time would be in easy reach of his hand if he
-should need it.
-
-He sat there for an hour, occasionally looking at the sleeping men,
-but for the most part studying through the glasses the horses that
-fed not far from him.
-
-After the light grew strong but a glance was needed to see that
-this was not a bunch of work horses, but was range stock, picked
-up anywhere. He could see the fresh brands on colts and yearlings,
-and could recognize some of them without his glasses. Through the
-glasses these fresh brands, many of which had as yet scarcely
-begun to peel, stood out very plainly, and in many cases the old
-brand could readily be distinguished. Besides this, there were
-many horses which he perfectly well knew, without seeing the
-brands,--animals that he recognized as occupying the range which
-he was accustomed to ride over. He chuckled to himself as he saw
-these, and thought, "My, my, wouldn't Mr. Sturgis and Powell and
-Joe be hot if they were here;" and then he thought, "I wish they
-were here, for if they were we could take in these three fellows
-mighty easy."
-
-From what he had already seen Hugh had made up his mind that this
-was a bunch of horses stolen from the range about the Swiftwater
-ranch, but he wished to wait a little longer in order to be sure
-who the men were who had them.
-
-After a while, one of the heaps that he was looking down upon
-stirred, and a few moments later the covering was thrown off, and a
-man sat up.
-
-He rubbed his eyes sleepily, and stretched and yawned, and finally
-put his hand under the edge of his blanket, pulled out his shoes,
-and then put them on and stood up. Hugh chuckled as he recognized
-Red McClusky, a man whom he well knew as living along the railroad.
-He was a cowboy who had come up from Texas and had worked at odd
-times on the range, but who spent most of his time in the town,
-consuming bad whiskey and occasionally disappeared for a few weeks,
-and then turned up again.
-
-McClusky filled his pipe and lighted it, and then going over to the
-fireplace, began to kindle a fire, at the same time calling out,
-"Here, get up, you lazy cusses; the sun's high, and we want to get
-breakfast." Soon after this the other two men sat up. One of them
-was Black Jack Dowling, another bad character along the railroad,
-well known to Hugh; but the third was a boy or young man, whom Hugh
-did not know, with a pleasant but rather weak face, who seemed a
-little bit afraid of both his companions.
-
-Dowling seemed in rather bad temper, and as he walked toward the
-creek growled at McClusky, asking him why he hadn't let them sleep
-longer. "We've had an awful hard ride," he said, "and I feel as if
-I could sleep all day, and all to-morrow too."
-
-"Pshaw," said McClusky, "that's no ride; if you're goin' to let a
-little pleasure gallop like that tire you out, you'd better stick
-to holding up trains. I feel as fresh to-day as if I hadn't been in
-the saddle for a week; don't you, Pete?" he laughed, speaking to
-the young man.
-
-"Yes," said Pete, "that wasn't no ride. I guess Jack here aint much
-used to the saddle."
-
-Dowling snarled out "Used to the saddle or not, you don't stir me
-out of this for two days more."
-
-"Well," said McClusky, "it don't make much difference when we go
-on, but I want to get these horses up north before snow comes, and
-we've got quite a ways to go. We ought to leave here to-morrow,
-sure; anyhow, the day after to-morrow."
-
-The fire was now burning, and operations for breakfast went on.
-The coffee-pot and frying pan were brought out from beneath the
-willows; Pete brought some water, and McClusky cooked, while the
-other two sat by the fire and smoked. Hugh had now seen enough,
-and began very slowly to work his way up the mountain. It was not
-long before he was out of sight and hearing of the camp, and taking
-up his blanket on the way, he went on up the stream. Gradually
-descending the hill, he at length reached the valley's level, and
-spent some time in the willow and alder bushes, studying the
-horses that were within sight. As nearly as he could figure, there
-were about a hundred head of horses, and most of them seemed pretty
-tired. After feeding for some time, they lay down and were seen
-resting all over the meadow.
-
-Returning to his horse, he led him for a long distance up the
-stream, to a point where the timber on both sides reached out well
-into the valley, and here crossing a little open spot, which was
-almost out of sight of the horses below, he turned down the stream,
-and keeping himself always well back from the valley in the timber,
-again stopped opposite the camp. From here, for a time he watched.
-The men loafed about the camp; but toward the middle of the morning
-the boy walked out among the horses, and catching one that was
-evidently picketed, took it back to camp, saddled it, and rode up
-the stream. He was not gone long, and indeed did not pass out of
-Hugh's sight. His only purpose was to round up the horses, driving
-those up stream down opposite the camp, and when he had done that
-he rode down stream and started the animals that were feeding there
-up to the others.
-
-Hugh could now make a close estimate of the number of the animals,
-and after having counted them a number of times, he made up his
-mind that there were between ninety and a hundred. Of these three
-seemed to be picketed, and he took careful note of their location,
-for he had already made up his mind what he intended to do.
-
-After the boy had rounded up the horses he caught A fresh horse,
-put it on picket and then riding back to the camp, unsaddled and
-turned loose the horse he had been riding.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XXII
-
-STEALING FROM HORSE THIEVES
-
-
-Hugh now knew all that he was likely to learn, and starting down
-stream, still well out of sight in the timber, he kept along the
-mountain side until the camp had been left two or three miles
-behind. Then mounting, he passed out into the open valley, and
-keeping close to its border, rode hard to the Platte River. It was
-but little after noon when he rode into the Platte bottom, and
-two hours more brought him in sight of his camp. The boys saw him
-while he was yet a long way off, and he could see them standing and
-watching him, and talking together as he approached.
-
-As he rode up to the lodge he said, "Well, boys, here I am. Now,
-I wish you two would go out and catch up old Baldy and your two
-riding horses, and bring them in and put them on picket. We've got
-to pack up, too, before very long, and get ready for a quick move
-and a long ride. When you get your horses we'll have something to
-eat, and I'll tell you what's happened."
-
-Hugh unsaddled, filled his pipe, started the fire, and began to
-cook some food, for by this time he was pretty hungry. While he was
-cooking, the boys came in and picketed the horses, and then Hugh
-said to them, "We'd better get our packs together, and pull down
-the lodge, and get everything ready for a move. I went up there
-and found the camp of these fellows. They're horse thieves, all
-right enough, and they've about a hundred head of horses, most of
-them Mr. Sturgis', but some are Powell's, and some belong to other
-neighbors of ours. Of course I could not see the brands on all the
-horses, but I saw the men that were driving them, and that's enough
-for me. I don't know, son, if you ever saw Red McClusky or Jack
-Dowling; but they're the men up there with the horses, with a boy
-not much older than you two, and I expect they've run 'em off and
-are going to take 'em up north.
-
-"Now, I figure that we can do one of two things. We can go up there
-and kill those fellows, and drive the horses back, or we can go up
-there and steal the horses from them, and leave them afoot, and
-just take the horses back on the range.
-
-"I feel some like killing the thieves, but I don't want you boys
-to be mixed up in anything of that kind; it might be bad for you.
-I reckon the best thing we can do will be to go up and steal the
-horses; steal 'em all if we can, so as to leave them fellows afoot.
-But if they've got sand to follow us, why then we've got to fight;
-because I know mighty well that they've no right to this property."
-
-The boys said nothing for a time, but when Hugh spoke of stealing
-the horses they looked at each other and grinned, with a delight
-that they could not conceal.
-
-"What are you fellows laughing at?" said Hugh, when he saw them.
-"This ain't no joke; this is serious business."
-
-"That's so, Hugh," said Jack, "but I guess we were both laughing
-because Joe suggested that if these were horse thieves, the best
-thing we could do would be to go and steal the horses."
-
-"Well," said Hugh, "I reckon that's what we've got to do; but I
-do hope that we can get 'em all. Now, to do that, we've each one
-of us got to do his part, and to do it the best way we know how.
-I'd rather have done it last night than do it to-night, because
-last night those fellows were tired, and to-night they'll sleep
-lighter; they may hear the horses walking off; but all the same, I
-don't believe they will. Now, you boys better saddle your horses,
-and we'll make up the packs and put 'em all together here, and put
-hobbles on the pack animals, so that there'll be no time lost in
-catching them, when we come back. You see, if we have to stop here
-it'll take quite a time to pack, and if we leave any horses up
-there for those fellows to ride, they may follow us for a way, and
-there's no saying what may happen. I don't want either of you boys
-to get shot, and I'm sure I don't want to get shot myself."
-
-After the meal was eaten, the packs were quickly made up, the pack
-horses were driven in, caught and hobbled, and the afternoon was
-not half gone when the three were riding back up the valley.
-
-Jack and Joe were somewhat impatient, but Hugh checked them.
-"There's no hurry," he said, "we can't do anything till the middle
-of the night. Those fellows may sit up round the fire for quite a
-while, and they might notice if the horses were moving much. I am
-in hopes that Joe and I can go up there afoot, and cut loose their
-riding horses, and then just slowly and quietly shove the whole
-bunch down until we get them well below the camp, and then we can
-start them at a good gait. There'll be no trouble about keeping
-them going fast, for we've got plenty of riding horses in the bunch
-there, and we can change often."
-
-The sun had not set when they entered the valley. They followed
-it up for what seemed to the boys a long distance, but at length
-Hugh stopped and dismounted, saying, "The camp is only about a mile
-above here."
-
-It was now dark night. Hugh sat down on the ground, holding his
-horse's bridle, and began to fill his pipe, and the boys sat close
-to him.
-
-"Now," he said, "I am going to take you boys up just where I came
-down this morning, and we'll get around these horses at the upper
-end of the valley, and work them down slowly on the other side from
-the camp. I'll go over and cut loose the horses that are picketed,
-and then we'll work on slowly until we get down well below this.
-Then we can go. I don't want either of you boys to shoot unless
-you have to; and if you have to, I'd rather have you shoot not
-to kill, but to cripple. If you get a chance, shoot at the man's
-shoulder, so he can't use his gun. On the other hand, I've heard
-that Dowling is handy with a gun in either hand. We've got to take
-some chances, of course. I don't expect we'll see anything of those
-fellows without we leave them a horse or two. If we do that, why
-then to-morrow morning they'll come on. You boys keep right close
-after me, and try to make as little noise as you can. Don't let
-your horses call. They may want to when they smell the others, but
-keep them from doing it if you can."
-
-Keeping well to the left, and close in under the timber, Hugh rode
-slowly along, and after a time they saw the light of the fire
-flickering on the other side of the valley, and occasionally could
-see shadows passing in front of it. As they moved along, they saw,
-from time to time, horses feeding, and once rode close to an old
-mare, whose little colt, not seeing them until they were near, gave
-a great bound into the air and rushed away for a few yards.
-
-Hugh kept on up the valley until it narrowed, going almost to the
-point where he had crossed in the morning. Then he stopped and said
-to the boys:
-
-"Now get off your horses and lead them. I reckon we're above all
-the horses, and now we'll go back down stream. Keep on the side
-away from the camp; keep spread out some; and when you come to any
-horses just walk toward them and get them to move along slowly.
-I'll keep out toward the middle until we get down near the camp;
-then, if the fire's gone down, I'll try to cut loose the horses,
-and I'll try to push them and all the others down the stream. It
-may take longer than we think, and you boys when you get down where
-we went into the timber, on the way up, get off your horses and lie
-down on the ground together and wait. See that you don't make any
-noise; see that you don't shoot me; keep your wits about you; and
-don't get excited or scared." The boys listened without a word.
-
-"Now," Hugh continued, "we'll start. Jack, you go over next to the
-timber, but keep fairly well out from the edge, and try to see all
-the time that you don't miss any of the horses. Joe, you keep out
-nearer the middle, and get all the horses you can, and both of you
-work as slow and careful as you know how."
-
-The three separated and set about their task. To Jack it seemed
-sort of shivery work, being off there alone. He wondered if
-anything would happen to Hugh or Joe; whether the thieves would
-find out what was being done, and would attack them; whether Hugh
-and Joe would meet him down at the end of the valley, and what in
-the world he would do if they did not. He had not much time for
-thoughts like these, however, for he had to watch the sky-line of
-the timber, and to figure how far he was from it; to look out for
-horses in front of him, and to travel along without stumbling, or
-running into little low bushes, or doing anything that would make a
-noise.
-
-Before long he saw his first horse, an old mare with a colt. He
-walked toward her, and as he approached, she began slowly to walk
-away. Then there were other horses off to his right and to his
-left, and he walked back and forward across the valley, sometimes
-seeing that the horses to his left were moving slowly along down
-the valley, which told him that Joe was doing his work, sometimes
-coming to a large bunch of brush, around which he had to pass in
-order to be sure that no horses were hidden there. All the time he
-kept a good lookout across the valley, to see if he could see the
-fire of the camp, and at length, after he had gone, as it seemed, a
-very long way, he recognized, under the opposite hills, a dim glow
-on the bushes, which told him of a fire burned down. This he was
-glad to see, because it made him feel sure that the thieves had
-gone to bed and were asleep.
-
-By this time he had in front of him a good many horses, all going
-quietly and feeding as they went. Now and then two or three would
-lag behind, and he was obliged to cross over and walk behind them,
-but they at once started on, and Jack felt pretty sure that, so
-far as his side of the valley was concerned, the horses had all
-been gathered. As he approached the place where they had entered
-the timber he began to hope that before long he would see Joe;
-and it was not very long after that that he saw one horse lagging
-behind all the rest, and as he went over to drive it along, he saw
-that someone was walking by it, and knew that this must be Joe. He
-wanted to go over and speak to him, but remembering that he had his
-own horses to look after, he restrained himself and kept on down
-the valley. At the same time he was glad to be sure that Joe was
-close by. Now, if only Hugh would appear, he should feel that they
-were all right. Now the valley grew more and more narrow, and the
-boys were closer together, and presently, as the horses bunched up
-to pass through a narrow place between two points of timber, Jack
-and Joe were almost side by side.
-
-"Everything all right, Joe?" said Jack.
-
-"All right," said Joe. "We've got a good bunch of horses."
-
-"Have you seen anything of Hugh?" said Jack.
-
-"No," said Joe, "I ain't seen Hugh, but the horses off to my left
-are moving along; I reckon he's there somewhere." The words were
-hardly spoken when suddenly, apparently from a horse that was
-walking just in front of them, Hugh's voice said:
-
-"All right, boys; I believe we've done the trick. I think we can
-mount now and go ahead. Don't start 'em up yet, we'll go two or
-three miles further, and then we'll let 'em sail." Both boys were
-delighted to hear Hugh, and they mounted and crowded close to him.
-
-"O Hugh," said Jack, "do you think we got 'em all?"
-
-"Well," said Hugh, "I don't know about that, we've got the most of
-'em. They may have riding horses cached in the brush somewhere.
-I was afraid to go right close to the camp, for fear some of 'em
-might be awake; but I got two picketed horses; there may be one
-hidden somewhere else; but I don't believe they've got horses
-enough to ride to-morrow, and I'm almighty sure they haven't got
-horses enough to catch us."
-
-"What time is it, Hugh, do you think?" said Jack.
-
-"Well, I don't know," said Hugh, "but it's considerable after the
-middle of the night. We've got plenty of time to get these horses
-down to camp, and pack, and start the whole outfit on before it
-gets day; and pretty soon I'm going to begin to hurry 'em. I want
-you two boys to drive the horses, and when we get out of the
-valley, I'm going to ride round them, and go ahead of them and
-lead them. Keep them going well until you hear me whoop; or if you
-can't hear me, until you see me. I shall ride pretty hard until
-we get near the camp, but we must stop the horses before we get
-there; otherwise they'll frighten our pack animals, and we won't
-be able to catch them. Now," said Hugh, as they came to a little
-enlargement of the valley, "I'll go ahead, and you give me a few
-minutes to get around them, and then start them up. When I hear
-them beginning to gallop, I'll go just ahead of them, and they'll
-all follow me."
-
-The cavalcade proceeded at a walk for ten minutes more, and then
-Joe and Jack began to hurry the animals, and before long they
-were galloping at a good rate of speed down the valley. When they
-reached the Platte bottom the horses turned off, following the
-trail by which they had come up, and swung steadily along at a good
-gait. Now and then Jack recognized, even in the darkness, a place
-that they had passed before, but for the most part the country all
-looked strange to him. It seemed as if they had been going for a
-long time when he thought he heard a faint whoop from in front, and
-at the same moment Joe called out to him:
-
-"Hold on, Jack; drop back. Hugh called, and we must let the horses
-stop."
-
-They drew their horses into a walk, and before long the animals
-they were driving also slowed down. Then, after a little while they
-heard Hugh, not far in front of them, calling out:
-
-"Come round here, boys, and help catch the pack animals, and put
-the packs on."
-
-They rode through the horses, which had now stopped and begun to
-feed, and it took but a short time to catch their pack horses, and
-saddle and pack up. Then turning loose the packs, they all three
-rode round behind the herd, and started it on again.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XXIII
-
-"DIED WITH HIS BOOTS ON"
-
-
-It was now growing light, and they drove the horses hard. Hugh rode
-steadily behind the bunch, while the boys were out on either flank,
-keeping them straight, and not permitting any lagging. Once they
-stopped for a little while and caught three fresh horses which Hugh
-pointed out, put their saddles on them and turned loose their own
-horses.
-
-The morning passed, and it was now the middle of the afternoon.
-The boys had noticed that Hugh often turned about and looked
-back up the level valley, and they themselves were also watching
-the back trail to see whether there was any pursuit. The sun was
-getting low, when far back up the valley was seen a speck of dust,
-which gradually grew larger, and underneath it they could see a
-black spot that was constantly growing nearer and nearer. It was
-evidently a man on horseback. After they had watched it for some
-time, Hugh motioned both boys to come over toward him, and riding
-there side by side in the thick dust kicked up by the hurrying
-herd, Hugh said to them:
-
-"Boys, there's one man coming, and he's on a good horse, and we've
-got to kill him, I expect. Let these horses stop now, and catch up
-three other animals and change the packs onto them, and by that
-time this fellow will be close up to us, and we can see what he
-wants."
-
-They slowed down their horses, the willing herd stopped and began
-to feed.
-
-Jack and Joe rode through it, and one by one caught the pack
-horses, which they brought back to Hugh. Then Hugh, sitting on his
-horse, pointed out to them other animals to catch, and they roped
-them, brought them up, and one by one the packs were transferred
-to the new horses. The horses did not like it very much, and one
-or two of them bucked, and to Jack it seemed rather nervous work
-to be doing this when the approaching horseman kept growing larger
-and larger, and when, for all he knew, before long bullets would be
-flying. The work was finished before the horseman was near them,
-and then Hugh told the boys to start the herd on again. But Jack
-demurred, and said:
-
-"Hold on, Hugh; are you going to stay here and meet this man? I
-think we all ought to stay, because something may happen."
-
-"Well," said Hugh, "I don't like the idea of your stopping. I'd
-rather have you go on and start these horses. Nothing's going to
-happen to me; I feel pretty sure of that. I shall be on the ground,
-and have every advantage over this fellow, if he wants trouble."
-
-"Hugh," said Joe, "how will this do: suppose Jack gets off twenty
-steps one side of you and I get off twenty steps on the other, and
-we won't do anything unless it looks like you were going to get
-hurt; then we can shoot."
-
-"All right," said Hugh, "if it will make you boys feel any easier;
-but I tell you nothing is going to happen. If that fellow don't
-stop when he gets within good rifle shot I'll stop him, and I won't
-hurt him either. If he's got so much sand that he won't know when a
-man's got the drop on him, I may have to hurt him, but I don't look
-to."
-
-The man came on; his horse was a great powerful beast and had been
-ridden hard, for it was covered with dust and foam. When he got
-within a hundred yards, Hugh dismounted, and stepping out in front
-of his horse, raised his rifle to his shoulder, and pointed it at
-the man. The man paid no attention to the motion, save to put his
-hand behind him and jerk from his holster a six-shooter. He called
-out something as he came on, but they could not distinguish what he
-said.
-
-"Hands up!" Hugh called; but the man paid no attention, and the
-distance between the party and the rider grew smaller.
-
-"Hands up!" Hugh shouted again, and then a third time; and still
-the man came on. Hugh fired, and the horse plunged forward on his
-knees throwing the rider far before him. It was Dowling.
-
-He struck on his head and hands and slid a little way along the
-earth, and then springing to his feet, with his left hand he pulled
-another six-shooter from his belt; but as he raised it, Hugh's
-rifle sounded again, and the man fell.
-
- [Illustration: "'HANDS UP!' HUGH CALLED."--_Page 268_]
-
-"Look out for him, boys! Don't go near him; he's like a grizzly
-bear; likely to be playing possum." Hugh watched the man with
-a wary eye, and was not surprised to see him after a moment
-raise himself on one elbow and feel about over the ground, in the
-effort to recover the pistol which he had dropped. Hugh had seen it
-fall, and knowing the man's quickness with the pistol, watched him
-carefully. In a moment, however, the man sank back and seemed to be
-breathing hard, and Hugh called to the boys:
-
-"Watch him, now, and I'll step up to him and get that gun; I'll be
-ready for him if he moves."
-
-Hugh stepped carefully but quickly forward, with his gun ready, and
-had almost reached the man, when he moved slightly, and Hugh sprang
-swiftly to one side, as the pistol was discharged without being
-raised. In a moment Hugh was on the man, and had taken the arm from
-him and thrown it to one side.
-
-Dowling was badly wounded, and it was evident he could not live
-long. When his pistols had been secured they did what they could to
-make him comfortable. Joe went to the river and brought water in
-his hat, and after a little, Dowling opened his eyes and spoke.
-
-"Well, you've got me," he said; "I was in hopes I'd get you. I
-couldn't stand it to have those horses taken, but I wish you'd
-taken this one, instead of leaving it for me to ride. However, we
-made a good try to get the stock, and we would have got it if it
-hadn't been for you. Where did you come from? We never saw anything
-of you."
-
-"We were just travelling down the river," said Hugh, "and saw the
-tracks, and I knew there wasn't any reason for a bunch of horses to
-be driven through this country; so I went back to look up and see
-what it meant, and I found that you'd got our horses."
-
-"Well," said Dowling, "a fool for luck! Anybody else coming through
-the country wouldn't have paid any attention to that horse trail,
-but you just had to do it.
-
-"I reckon I've got it," he went on; "and I expect it's about time
-too, but I hate almightily to be downed by an old man. I'd a heap
-sight rather have had one of them young fellows kill me."
-
-"Well," said Hugh, "I expect when a man's time comes, it don't make
-much difference how he gets killed."
-
-"No," said Dowling, "I expect maybe it don't. I always allowed I
-die with my boots on, anyhow, and here I am."
-
-During the few moments that had elapsed since he had received his
-wound his voice had grown much weaker. He was not bleeding much,
-but Hugh shook his head as he looked at the wound.
-
-"Have some more water, Dowling?" he said.
-
-"Yes, a little," said Dowling; but as Hugh raised him up to drink,
-he began to choke, and in a moment, after a shudder or two, lay
-dead.
-
-"Well, boys," said Hugh, "we've got to bury him, and then move
-along. Suppose you two go over onto the edge of that bluff and
-scrape away the clay, as much as you can with your knives, and I'll
-bring the body over, and put his saddle-blanket over him, and we'll
-cover him up."
-
-It had all happened so quickly, and there had been so much
-excitement about it, that Jack hardly understood or realized what
-had happened. He and Joe walked over to the bluff, and scraping
-away the soft yellow clay, soon made a place six or eight feet
-long, and presently Hugh came over, carrying the man on his
-shoulder, and they laid him in his shallow grave. Hugh took off his
-belt, and looked through his pockets to see if he had any papers by
-which he might be identified, but found none. They covered him with
-the earth, and brought flat stones that had fallen down from the
-top of the bluff, and piled them upon the grave, to protect it from
-the wolves.
-
-Then Hugh went back, and picking up the two pistols that Dowling
-had dropped, shoved them in the holsters, and holding out the belt
-to Jack, he said, "You want to wear this, son?"
-
-"Why, yes, Hugh, I'd like to have it to remember this day by,
-though there are some things that I don't much care to remember."
-
-"Well," said Hugh, "this is the way things used to be in the far
-west, but I thought we'd about got through with it by this time.
-However, some of the old spirit seems to crop out now and then."
-
-They mounted, and started the herd along again. They had not gone
-far before Hugh said, "I want you boys to drive these animals on
-three or four miles down the creek, and leave them there; but cut
-out the pack horses, and we'll camp right here."
-
-Camp was made in a bunch of cottonwood brush, but the lodge was not
-put up. The pack horses were hobbled, and then the boys drove the
-loose horses some distance further down the stream, and returning
-found the camp dark, but supper ready.
-
-"I thought," said Hugh, "that there was just a chance that those
-two other fellows might follow us down and try to take some of the
-horses back again; so we had better stop here, without any fire,
-and with the horses kept close, and make an early start in the
-morning."
-
-Hugh had them up long before day. They built no fire, but ate some
-dried meat, and started on. The tired horses were found just where
-they had been left, were pushed along at a good gait all day and
-crossed the Platte; and the next night they drove them into Mr.
-Sturgis' ranch to the great astonishment of all there, and later of
-Powell, and the other men from whom horses had been stolen.
-
-Great was the credit received by all three of those who had brought
-back the stolen horses. Mr. Sturgis gave to Jack and Joe each three
-good riding animals; and to this day Jack talks of the only horse
-stealing expedition he was ever on.
-
-Transcriber's note:
- In Chapter I there is the word "Hi d[)a]t sa" which contains an
- "a" with a breve accent mark above it which is rendered as [)a].
- In Chapter II is the word " Ass[)i]ne" which contains an "i"
- with breve accent mark above, [)i].
-
-
-
-
-
-End of Project Gutenberg's Jack in the Rockies, by George Bird Grinnell
-
-*** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK JACK IN THE ROCKIES ***
-
-***** This file should be named 44671-8.txt or 44671-8.zip *****
-This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
- http://www.gutenberg.org/4/4/6/7/44671/
-
-Produced by David Edwards, Mary Akers and the Online
-Distributed Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net (This
-file was produced from images generously made available
-by The Internet Archive)
-
-
-Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions
-will be renamed.
-
-Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no
-one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation
-(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without
-permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules,
-set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to
-copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to
-protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project
-Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you
-charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you
-do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the
-rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose
-such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and
-research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do
-practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is
-subject to the trademark license, especially commercial
-redistribution.
-
-
-
-*** START: FULL LICENSE ***
-
-THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
-PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
-
-To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
-distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
-(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project
-Gutenberg-tm License available with this file or online at
- www.gutenberg.org/license.
-
-
-Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works
-
-1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
-and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
-(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
-the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy
-all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession.
-If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the
-terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or
-entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8.
-
-1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
-used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
-agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
-things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
-paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement
-and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
-works. See paragraph 1.E below.
-
-1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation"
-or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the
-collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an
-individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are
-located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from
-copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative
-works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg
-are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project
-Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by
-freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of
-this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with
-the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by
-keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project
-Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others.
-
-1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
-what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in
-a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check
-the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement
-before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or
-creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project
-Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning
-the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United
-States.
-
-1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
-
-1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate
-access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently
-whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the
-phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed,
-copied or distributed:
-
-This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
-almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
-re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
-with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
-
-1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived
-from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is
-posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied
-and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees
-or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work
-with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the
-work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1
-through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the
-Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or
-1.E.9.
-
-1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
-with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
-must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional
-terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked
-to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the
-permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work.
-
-1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
-License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
-work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
-
-1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
-electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
-prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
-active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm License.
-
-1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
-compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any
-word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or
-distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than
-"Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version
-posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org),
-you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a
-copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon
-request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other
-form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm
-License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
-
-1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
-performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
-unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
-
-1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
-access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided
-that
-
-- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
- the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
- you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is
- owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he
- has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the
- Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments
- must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you
- prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax
- returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and
- sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the
- address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to
- the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation."
-
-- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
- you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
- does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
- License. You must require such a user to return or
- destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium
- and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of
- Project Gutenberg-tm works.
-
-- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any
- money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
- electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days
- of receipt of the work.
-
-- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
- distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
-
-1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set
-forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from
-both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael
-Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the
-Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
-
-1.F.
-
-1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
-effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
-public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm
-collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
-works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain
-"Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or
-corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual
-property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a
-computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by
-your equipment.
-
-1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
-of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
-liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
-fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
-LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
-PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
-TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
-LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
-INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
-DAMAGE.
-
-1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
-defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
-receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
-written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
-received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with
-your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with
-the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a
-refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity
-providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to
-receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy
-is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further
-opportunities to fix the problem.
-
-1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
-in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS', WITH NO OTHER
-WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
-WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
-
-1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
-warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages.
-If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the
-law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be
-interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by
-the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any
-provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions.
-
-1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
-trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
-providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance
-with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production,
-promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works,
-harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees,
-that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do
-or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm
-work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any
-Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause.
-
-
-Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
-electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers
-including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists
-because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from
-people in all walks of life.
-
-Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
-assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
-goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
-remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
-and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations.
-To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
-and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4
-and the Foundation information page at www.gutenberg.org
-
-
-Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive
-Foundation
-
-The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
-501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
-state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
-Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
-number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg
-Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent
-permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
-
-The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S.
-Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered
-throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at 809
-North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887. Email
-contact links and up to date contact information can be found at the
-Foundation's web site and official page at www.gutenberg.org/contact
-
-For additional contact information:
- Dr. Gregory B. Newby
- Chief Executive and Director
- gbnewby@pglaf.org
-
-Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
-Literary Archive Foundation
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
-spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
-increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
-freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
-array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
-($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
-status with the IRS.
-
-The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
-charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
-States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
-considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
-with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
-where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To
-SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any
-particular state visit www.gutenberg.org/donate
-
-While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
-have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
-against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
-approach us with offers to donate.
-
-International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
-any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
-outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
-
-Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
-methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
-ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations.
-To donate, please visit: www.gutenberg.org/donate
-
-
-Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
-works.
-
-Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm
-concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared
-with anyone. For forty years, he produced and distributed Project
-Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support.
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
-editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S.
-unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily
-keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition.
-
-Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility:
-
- www.gutenberg.org
-
-This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
-including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
-subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.